HIG 3.31.2015 - 10-Q Document


UNITED STATES
SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION
Washington, D.C. 20549
____________________________________ 
FORM 10-Q
 ____________________________________
(Mark One)
ý
QUARTERLY REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934
For the quarterly period ended March 31, 2015
or
¨
TRANSITION REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934
For the transition period from ____________ to ______________
Commission file number 001-13958
____________________________________ 
THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
(Exact name of registrant as specified in its charter)
Delaware
 
13-3317783
(State or other jurisdiction of incorporation or organization)
 
(I.R.S. Employer Identification No.)
One Hartford Plaza, Hartford, Connecticut 06155
(Address of principal executive offices) (Zip Code)
(860) 547-5000
(Registrant’s telephone number, including area code)
Indicate by check mark:
Yes
 
No
 
 
 
 
•     whether the registrant (1) has filed all reports required to be filed by Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was required to file such reports), and (2) has been subject to such filing requirements for the past 90 days.
ý
 
¨
 
 
 
 
•     whether the registrant has submitted electronically and posted on its corporate Web site, if any, every Interactive Data File required to be submitted and posted pursuant to Rule 405 of Regulation S-T during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was required to submit and post such files).
ý
 
¨
 
 
 
 
•     whether the registrant is a large accelerated filer, an accelerated filer, a non-accelerated filer, or a smaller reporting company. See definitions of “large accelerated filer,” “accelerated filer” and “smaller reporting company” in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange Act.
 
 
 
Large accelerated filer x
 
Accelerated filer  ¨
 
Non-accelerated filer  ¨
 
Smaller reporting company  ¨
•     whether the registrant is a shell company (as defined in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange Act.)
¨
 
ý
As of April 22, 2015, there were outstanding 419,928,818 shares of Common Stock, $0.01 par value per share, of the registrant.

1



THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
QUARTERLY REPORT ON FORM 10-Q
FOR THE QUARTERLY PERIOD ENDED MARCH 31, 2015
TABLE OF CONTENTS
Item
Description
Page
 
 
1.      
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
2.      
3.      
4.      
 
 
1.      
1A.   
2.      
 
 
 
6.      
 
 
 
 
 



2



Forward-Looking Statements
Certain of the statements contained herein are forward-looking statements made pursuant to the safe harbor provisions of the Private Securities Litigation Reform Act of 1995. Forward-looking statements can be identified by words such as “anticipates,” “intends,” “plans,” “seeks,” “believes,” “estimates,” “expects,” “projects,” and similar references to future periods.
Forward-looking statements are based on our current expectations and assumptions regarding economic, competitive, legislative and other developments. Because forward-looking statements relate to the future, they are subject to inherent uncertainties, risks and changes in circumstances that are difficult to predict.
They have been made based upon management’s expectations and beliefs concerning future developments and their potential effect upon The Hartford Financial Services Group, Inc. and its subsidiaries (collectively, the “Company” or “The Hartford”). Future developments may not be in line with management’s expectations or may have unanticipated effects. Actual results could differ materially from expectations, depending on the evolution of various factors, including those set forth in Part I, Item 1A, Risk Factors in The Hartford’s 2014 Form 10-K Annual Report, and those identified from time to time in our other filings with the Securities and Exchange Commission. These important risks and uncertainties include:
challenges related to the Company’s current operating environment, including global political, economic and market conditions, and the effect of financial market disruptions, economic downturns or other potentially adverse macroeconomic developments on the attractiveness of our products, the returns in our investment portfolios and the hedging costs associated with our variable annuities business;
financial risk related to the continued reinvestment of our investment portfolios and performance of our hedge program for our runoff annuity block;
market risks associated with our business, including changes in interest rates, credit spreads, equity prices, market volatility and foreign exchange rates, commodities prices and implied volatility levels, as well as continuing uncertainty in key sectors such as the global real estate market;
the impact on our investment portfolio if our investment portfolio is concentrated in any particular segment of the economy;
risk associated with the use of analytical models in making decisions in key areas such as underwriting, capital, hedging, reserving, and catastrophe risk management;
the potential for further acceleration of deferred policy acquisition cost amortization;
the potential for further impairments of our goodwill or the potential for changes in valuation allowances against deferred tax assets;
the potential for differing interpretations of the methodologies, estimations and assumptions that underlie the valuation of the Company’s financial instruments that could result in changes to investment valuations;
the difficulty in predicting the Company’s potential exposure for asbestos and environmental claims;
the subjective determinations that underlie the Company’s evaluation of other-than-temporary impairments on available-for-sale securities;
the impact on our statutory capital of various factors, including many that are outside the Company’s control, which can in turn affect our credit and financial strength ratings, cost of capital, regulatory compliance and other aspects of our business and results;
risks to our business, financial position, prospects and results associated with negative rating actions or downgrades in the Company’s financial strength and credit ratings or negative rating actions or downgrades relating to our investments;
losses due to nonperformance or defaults by others, including reinsurers, sourcing partners, derivative counterparties and other third parties;
the potential for losses due to our reinsurers’ unwillingness or inability to meet their obligations under reinsurance contracts and the availability, pricing and adequacy of reinsurance to protect us against losses;
the possibility of unfavorable loss development including with respect to long-tailed exposures;
the possibility of a pandemic, earthquake, or other natural or man-made disaster that may adversely affect our businesses;
weather and other natural physical events, including the severity and frequency of storms, hail, winter storms, hurricanes and tropical storms, as well as climate change and its potential impact on weather patterns;
the uncertain effects of emerging claim and coverage issues;

3



the Company’s ability to effectively price its property and casualty policies, including its ability to obtain regulatory consents to pricing actions or to non-renewal or withdrawal of certain product lines;
technology innovations, such as telematics and other usage-based methods of determining premiums, auto technology advancements that improve driver safety and technologies that facilitate ride or home sharing, may alter demand for the Company’s products, impact the frequency or severity of losses and/or impact the way the Company markets, distributes and underwrites its products;
the possible occurrence of terrorist attacks and the Company’s ability to contain its exposure, including limitations on coverage from the federal government under applicable reinsurance terrorism laws;
volatility in our statutory and United States ("U.S.") GAAP earnings and potential material changes to our results resulting from our adjustment of our risk management program to emphasize protection of economic value;
the cost and other effects of increased regulation as a result of the implementation of the Dodd-Frank Wall Street Reform and Consumer Protection Act of 2010, and the potential effect of other domestic and foreign regulatory developments, including those that could adversely impact the demand for the Company’s products, operating costs and required capital levels;
unfavorable judicial or legislative developments;
regulatory limitations on the ability of the Company and certain of its subsidiaries to declare and pay dividends;
the impact of changes in federal or state tax laws;
the impact of potential changes in accounting principles and related financial reporting requirements;
regulatory requirements that could delay, deter or prevent a takeover attempt that shareholders might consider in their best interests;
the risks, challenges and uncertainties associated with our capital management plan, expense reduction initiatives and other actions, which may include acquisitions, divestitures or restructurings;
actions by our competitors, many of which are larger or have greater financial resources than we do;
the Company’s ability to market, distribute and provide investment advisory services in relation to our products through current and future distribution channels and advisory firms;
the Company’s ability to maintain the availability of its systems and safeguard the security of its data in the event of a disaster, cyber or other information security incident or other unanticipated event;
the risk that our framework for managing operational risks may not be effective in mitigating material risk and loss to the Company;
the potential for difficulties arising from outsourcing and similar third-party relationships;
the Company’s ability to protect its intellectual property and defend against claims of infringement; and
other factors described in such forward-looking statements.
Any forward-looking statement made by the Company in this document speaks only as of the date of the filing of this Form 10-Q. Factors or events that could cause the Company’s actual results to differ may emerge from time to time, and it is not possible for the Company to predict all of them. The Company undertakes no obligation to publicly update any forward-looking statement, whether as a result of new information, future developments or otherwise.

4



Part I. FINANCIAL INFORMATION
Item 1.
Financial Statements
REPORT OF INDEPENDENT REGISTERED PUBLIC ACCOUNTING FIRM
To the Board of Directors and Stockholders of
The Hartford Financial Services Group, Inc.
Hartford, Connecticut

We have reviewed the accompanying condensed consolidated balance sheet of The Hartford Financial Services Group, Inc. and subsidiaries (the "Company") as of March 31, 2015, and the related condensed consolidated statements of operations, comprehensive income, changes in stockholders' equity and cash flows for the three-month periods ended March 31, 2015 and 2014. These interim financial statements are the responsibility of the Company's management.
We conducted our reviews in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States). A review of interim financial information consists principally of applying analytical procedures and making inquiries of persons responsible for financial and accounting matters. It is substantially less in scope than an audit conducted in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States), the objective of which is the expression of an opinion regarding the financial statements taken as a whole. Accordingly, we do not express such an opinion.
Based on our reviews, we are not aware of any material modifications that should be made to such condensed consolidated interim financial statements for them to be in conformity with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America.
We have previously audited, in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States), the consolidated balance sheet of the Company as of December 31, 2014, and the related consolidated statements of operations, comprehensive income, changes in stockholders' equity, and cash flows for the year then ended (not presented herein); and in our report dated February 27, 2015, we expressed an unqualified opinion on those consolidated financial statements. In our opinion, the information set forth in the accompanying condensed consolidated balance sheet as of December 31, 2014 is fairly stated, in all material respects, in relation to the consolidated balance sheet from which it has been derived.

DELOITTE & TOUCHE LLP
Hartford, Connecticut
April 27, 2015



5

Table of Contents
THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
Condensed Consolidated Statements of Operations

 
Three Months Ended March 31,
(In millions, except for per share data)
2015
2014
 
(Unaudited)
Revenues
 
 
Earned premiums
$
3,322

$
3,302

Fee income
459

496

Net investment income
809

824

Net realized capital gains (losses):
 
 
Total other-than-temporary impairment (“OTTI”) losses
(12
)
(23
)
OTTI losses recognized in other comprehensive income (“OCI”)

1

Net OTTI losses recognized in earnings
(12
)
(22
)
Other net realized capital gains (losses)
17

(13
)
Total net realized capital gains (losses)
5

(35
)
Other revenues
22

25

Total revenues
4,617

4,612

Benefits, losses and expenses
 
 
Benefits, losses and loss adjustment expenses
2,563

2,576

Amortization of deferred policy acquisition costs and present value of future profits
387

396

Insurance operating costs and other expenses
948

936

Interest expense
94

95

Total benefits, losses and expenses
3,992

4,003

Income from continuing operations before income taxes
625

609

Income tax expense
158

143

Income from continuing operations, net of tax
467

466

Income from discontinued operations, net of tax

29

Net income
$
467

$
495

Income from continuing operations, net of tax, per common share
 
 
Basic
$
1.11

$
1.04

Diluted
$
1.08

$
0.97

Net income per common share
 
 
Basic
$
1.11

$
1.10

Diluted
$
1.08

$
1.03

Cash dividends declared per common share
$
0.18

$
0.15

See Notes to Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements.

6

Table of Contents
THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
Condensed Consolidated Statements of Comprehensive Income (Loss)

 
Three Months Ended March 31,
(In millions)
2015
2014
 
(Unaudited)
Comprehensive Income
 
 
Net income
$
467

$
495

Other comprehensive income (loss):
 
 
Change in net unrealized gain on securities
208

699

Change in OTTI losses recognized in other comprehensive income
(3
)
2

Change in net gain on cash flow hedging instruments
27

13

Change in foreign currency translation adjustments
(20
)
17

Change in pension and other postretirement plan adjustments
10

7

Total other comprehensive income
222

738

Total comprehensive income
$
689

$
1,233

See Notes to Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements.

7

Table of Contents
THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
Condensed Consolidated Balance Sheets

(In millions, except for share and per share data)
March 31,
2015
December 31, 2014
 
(Unaudited)
Assets
 
Investments:
 
 
Fixed maturities, available-for-sale, at fair value (amortized cost of $56,104 and $55,362)
$
60,555

$
59,384

Fixed maturities, at fair value using the fair value option (includes variable interest entity assets of $217 and $218)
520

488

Equity securities, available-for-sale, at fair value (cost of $1,129 and $1,027) (includes equity securities, at fair value using the fair value option, of $402 and $348)
1,148

1,047

Mortgage loans (net of allowances for loan losses of $21 and $18)
5,697

5,556

Policy loans, at outstanding balance
1,452

1,431

Limited partnerships and other alternative investments (includes variable interest entity assets of $2 and $3)
2,923

2,942

Other investments
630

547

Short-term investments (includes variable interest entity assets, at fair value, of $8 and $16)
3,651

4,883

Total investments
76,576

76,278

Cash (includes variable interest entity assets, at fair value, of $12 and $9)
500

399

Premiums receivable and agents’ balances, net
3,497

3,429

Reinsurance recoverables, net
22,737

22,920

Deferred policy acquisition costs
1,764

1,823

Deferred income taxes, net
2,636

2,897

Goodwill
498

498

Property and equipment, net
848

831

Other assets
2,101

1,236

Separate account assets
135,803

134,702

Total assets
$
246,960

$
245,013

Liabilities
 
 
Reserve for future policy benefits and unpaid losses and loss adjustment expenses
$
41,523

$
41,444

Other policyholder funds and benefits payable
32,101

32,532

Unearned premiums
5,383

5,255

Short-term debt
167

456

Long-term debt
5,653

5,653

Other liabilities (includes variable interest entity liabilities of $5 and $6)
7,253

6,251

Separate account liabilities
135,803

134,702

Total liabilities
227,883

226,293

Commitments and Contingencies (Note 8)
 
 
Stockholders’ Equity
 
 
Common stock, $0.01 par value — 1,500,000,000 shares authorized, 490,923,222 and 490,923,222 shares issued
5

5

Additional paid-in capital
8,996

9,123

Retained earnings
11,583

11,191

Treasury stock, at cost — 69,533,810 and 66,507,690 shares
(2,657
)
(2,527
)
Accumulated other comprehensive income, net of tax
1,150

928

Total stockholders’ equity
19,077

18,720

Total liabilities and stockholders’ equity
$
246,960

$
245,013

See Notes to Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements.

8

Table of Contents
THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
Condensed Consolidated Statements of Changes in Stockholders’ Equity


 
Three Months Ended March 31,
(In millions, except for share data)
2015
2014
 
(Unaudited)
Common Stock
$
5

$
5

Additional Paid-in Capital, beginning of period
9,123

9,894

Issuance of shares under incentive and stock compensation plans
(150
)
(49
)
Stock-based compensation plans expense
16

19

Tax benefit on employee stock options and share-based awards
26

3

Issuance of shares for warrant exercise
(19
)
(318
)
Additional Paid-in Capital, end of period
8,996

9,549

Retained Earnings, beginning of period
11,191

10,683

Net income
467

495

Dividends declared on common stock
(75
)
(67
)
Retained Earnings, end of period
11,583

11,111

Treasury Stock, at Cost, beginning of period
(2,527
)
(1,598
)
Treasury stock acquired
(250
)
(300
)
Issuance of shares under incentive and stock compensation plans
154

43

Net shares acquired related to employee incentive and stock compensation plans
(53
)
(13
)
Issuance of shares for warrant exercise
19

318

Treasury Stock, at Cost, end of period
(2,657
)
(1,550
)
Accumulated Other Comprehensive Income (Loss), net of tax, beginning of period
928

(79
)
Total other comprehensive income
222

738

Accumulated Other Comprehensive Income, net of tax, end of period
1,150

659

Total Stockholders’ Equity
$
19,077

$
19,774

Common Shares Outstanding beginning of period (in thousands)
424,416

453,290

Treasury stock acquired
(6,128
)
(8,821
)
Issuance of shares under incentive and stock compensation plans
3,923

996

Return of shares under incentive and stock compensation plans and other to treasury stock
(1,299
)
(357
)
Issuance of shares for warrant exercise
477

7,378

Common Shares Outstanding, at end of period
421,389

452,486

See Notes to Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements.

9

Table of Contents
THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
Condensed Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows

 
Three Months Ended March 31,
(In millions)
2015
2014
Operating Activities
(Unaudited)
Net income (loss)
$
467

$
495

Adjustments to reconcile net income to net cash provided by operating activities:
 
 
Amortization of deferred policy acquisition costs and present value of future profits
387

396

Additions to deferred policy acquisition costs and present value of future profits
(354
)
(350
)
Net realized capital (gains) losses
(5
)
86

Depreciation and amortization
101

60

Other operating activities, net
22

(97
)
Change in assets and liabilities:
 
 
Increase in reserve for future policy benefits and unpaid losses and loss adjustment expenses and unearned premiums
120

107

Decrease in reinsurance recoverables
37

3

Increase in receivables and other assets
(449
)
(69
)
Decrease in payables and accruals
(47
)
(399
)
Decrease in accrued and deferred income taxes
168

117

Net disbursements from investment contracts related to policyholder funds—international variable annuities

(2,458
)
Net decrease in equity securities, trading

2,458

Net cash provided by operating activities
447

349

Investing Activities
 
 
Proceeds from the sale/maturity/prepayment of:
 
 
Fixed maturities, available-for-sale
6,584

8,015

Fixed maturities, fair value option
36

55

Equity securities, available-for-sale
363

118

Mortgage loans
104

96

Partnerships
179

123

Payments for the purchase of:
 
 
Fixed maturities, available-for-sale
(7,375
)
(7,654
)
Fixed maturities, fair value option
(59
)
(168
)
Equity securities, available-for-sale
(566
)
(28
)
Mortgage loans
(154
)
(204
)
Partnerships
(106
)
(70
)
Net proceeds from (payments for) derivatives
45

(17
)
Net increase (decrease) in policy loans
(24
)
9

Net additions to property and equipment
(58
)
(33
)
Net proceeds from (payments for) short-term investments
1,325

(44
)
Other investing activities, net
1

(2
)
Net cash provided by investing activities
295

196

Financing Activities
 
 
Deposits and other additions to investment and universal life-type contracts
1,209

817

Withdrawals and other deductions from investment and universal life-type contracts
(4,682
)
(4,687
)
Net transfers from separate accounts related to investment and universal life-type contracts
3,175

3,581

Repayments at maturity or settlement of consumer notes
(2
)
(6
)
Net proceeds from securities loaned or sold under agreements to repurchase
323

147

Repayment of debt
(289
)
(200
)
Net issuance (return) of shares under incentive and stock compensation plans, excess tax benefit, and other
(25
)
30

Treasury stock acquired
(250
)
(300
)
Dividends paid on common stock
(78
)
(67
)
Net cash used for financing activities
(619
)
(685
)
Foreign exchange rate effect on cash
(22
)
(3
)
Net decrease in cash
101

(143
)
Cash – beginning of period
399

1,428

Cash – end of period
$
500

$
1,285

Supplemental Disclosure of Cash Flow Information
 
 
Income taxes received
$
47

$
126

Interest paid
$
77

$
82

See Notes to Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements

10

Table of Contents
THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(Dollar amounts in millions, except for per share data, unless otherwise stated)
(Unaudited)



1. Basis of Presentation and Significant Accounting Policies
The Hartford Financial Services Group, Inc. is a holding company for insurance and financial services subsidiaries that provide property and casualty insurance, group life and disability products and mutual funds to individual and business customers in the United States (collectively, “The Hartford”, the “Company”, “we” or “our”). Also, the Company continues to runoff life and annuity products previously sold.
On June 30, 2014, the Company completed the sale of all of the issued and outstanding equity of Hartford Life Insurance KK, a Japanese company ("HLIKK"), to ORIX Life Insurance Corporation, a subsidiary of ORIX Corporation, a Japanese company. The operations of the Company's Japan business are reported as discontinued operations. For further information regarding discontinued operations, see the following Discontinued Operations section and Note 12 - Discontinued Operations of Notes to Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements.
The Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements have been prepared in accordance with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America (“U.S. GAAP”) for interim financial information, which differ materially from the accounting practices prescribed by various insurance regulatory authorities. These Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements and Notes should be read in conjunction with the Consolidated Financial Statements and Notes thereto included in the Company's 2014 Form 10-K Annual Report. The results of operations for interim periods are not necessarily indicative of the results that may be expected for the full year.
The accompanying Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements and Notes are unaudited. These financial statements reflect all adjustments (generally consisting only of normal accruals) which are, in the opinion of management, necessary for the fair presentation of the financial position, results of operations and cash flows for the interim periods. The Company's significant accounting policies are summarized in Note 1 - Basis of Presentation and Significant Accounting Policies of Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements included in the Company's 2014 Form 10-K Annual Report.
Consolidation
The Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements include the accounts of The Hartford Financial Services Group, Inc., companies in which the Company directly or indirectly has a controlling financial interest and those variable interest entities (“VIEs”) which the Company is required to consolidate. Entities in which the Company has significant influence over the operating and financing decisions but is not required to consolidate are reported using the equity method. For further information on VIEs see Note 5 - Investments and Derivative Instruments of Notes to Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements. All intercompany transactions and balances between The Hartford and its subsidiaries and affiliates have been eliminated.
Discontinued Operations
The results of operations of a component of the Company are reported in discontinued operations when certain criteria are met as of the date of disposal, or earlier if classified as held-for-sale. When a component is identified for discontinued operations reporting, amounts for prior periods are retrospectively reclassified as discontinued operations. Prior to January 1, 2015, components were identified as discontinued operations if the operations and cash flows of the component had been or would be eliminated from the ongoing operations of the Company as a result of the disposal transaction and the Company would not have any significant continuing involvement in the operations of the component after the disposal transaction. For transactions occurring January 1, 2015 or later, under updated guidance issued by the Financial Accounting Standards Board, components are identified as discontinued operations if they are a major part of an entity’s operations and financial results such as a separate major line of business or a separate major geographical area of operations regardless of whether the Company has significant continuing involvement in the operations of the component after the disposal transaction. For information on the specific discontinued operations, see Note 12 - Discontinued Operations of Notes to Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements.
Use of Estimates
The preparation of financial statements, in conformity with U.S. GAAP, requires management to make estimates and assumptions that affect the reported amounts of assets and liabilities and the disclosure of contingent assets and liabilities at the date of the financial statements and the reported amounts of revenues and expenses during the reporting period. Actual results could differ from those estimates.

11

THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)
1. Basis of Presentation and Significant Accounting Policies (continued)

The most significant estimates include those used in determining property and casualty insurance product reserves, net of reinsurance; estimated gross profits used in the valuation and amortization of assets and liabilities associated with variable annuity and other universal life-type contracts; evaluation of other-than-temporary impairments on available-for-sale securities and valuation allowances on investments; living benefits required to be fair valued; goodwill impairment; valuation of investments and derivative instruments; valuation allowance on deferred tax assets; and contingencies relating to corporate litigation and regulatory matters. Certain of these estimates are particularly sensitive to market conditions, and deterioration and/or volatility in the worldwide debt or equity markets could have a material impact on the Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements.
Reclassifications
Certain reclassifications have been made to prior period financial information to conform to the current period presentation.
2. Earnings Per Common Share
The following table presents the computation of basic and diluted earnings per common share.
 
Three Months Ended March 31,
(In millions, except for per share data)
2015
2014
Earnings
 
 
Income from continuing operations, net of tax
$
467

$
466

Income from discontinued operations, net of tax
$

$
29

Net income
$
467

$
495

Shares
 
 
Weighted average common shares outstanding, basic
422.6

449.8

Dilutive effect of stock compensation plans
5.5

6.2

Dilutive effect of warrants
5.6

22.6

Weighted average common shares outstanding and dilutive potential common shares
433.7

478.6

Earnings per common share
 
 
Basic
 
 
Income from continuing operations, net of tax
$
1.11

$
1.04

Income from discontinued operations, net of tax

0.06

Net income per common share
$
1.11

$
1.10

Diluted
 
 
Income from continuing operations, net of tax
$
1.08

$
0.97

Income from discontinued operations, net of tax

0.06

Net income per common share
$
1.08

$
1.03

Basic earnings per share is computed based on the weighted average number of common shares outstanding during the year. Diluted potential common shares are included in the calculation of diluted per share amounts provided there is income from continuing operations, net of tax. Diluted earnings per share includes the dilutive effect of assumed exercise or issuance of warrants and stock-based awards under compensation plans using the treasury stock method.
Under the treasury stock method, for warrants and stock-based awards, shares are assumed to be issued and then reduced for the number of shares repurchaseable with theoretical proceeds at the average market price for the period. Contingently issuable shares are included for the number of shares issuable assuming the end of the reporting period was the end of the contingency period, if dilutive.


12

Table of Contents
THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)
3. Segment Information

The Company currently conducts business principally in six reporting segments, as well as a Corporate category. The Company's revenues from continuing operations are generated primarily in the United States ("U.S."). Any foreign sourced revenue in continuing operations is immaterial.
The Company’s reporting segments, as well as the Corporate category, are as follows:
Commercial Lines
Commercial Lines provides workers’ compensation, property, automobile, marine, livestock, liability and umbrella coverages primarily throughout the U.S., along with a variety of customized insurance products and risk management services including professional liability, bond, surety and specialty casualty coverages.
Personal Lines
Personal Lines provides standard automobile, homeowners and personal umbrella coverages to individuals across the U.S., including a special program designed exclusively for members of AARP.
Property & Casualty Other Operations
Property & Casualty Other Operations includes certain property and casualty operations, managed by the Company, that have discontinued writing new business and including substantially all of the Company’s asbestos and environmental exposures.
Group Benefits
Group Benefits provides employers, associations, affinity groups and financial institutions with group life, accident and disability coverage, along with other products and services, including voluntary benefits, and group retiree health.
Mutual Funds
Mutual Funds offers investment products for retail and retirement accounts and provides investment management and administrative services such as product design, implementation and oversight. This business also includes the runoff of the mutual funds supporting the Company's variable annuity products.
Talcott Resolution
Talcott Resolution is comprised of runoff business from the Company's individual annuity, institutional, and private-placement life insurance businesses. The Company's individual annuity business consists of annuity products for individuals, which include variable, fixed, and payout annuity products. In addition, Talcott Resolution includes the retained Japan fixed payout annuity liabilities, as well as the Company's discontinued Japan annuity business prior to its sale in 2014.
Corporate
The Company includes in the Corporate category the Company’s debt financing and related interest expense, as well as other capital raising activities, certain purchase accounting adjustments and other charges not allocated to the segments.
Financial Measures and Other Segment Information
Certain transactions between segments occur during the year that primarily relate to tax settlements, insurance coverage, expense reimbursements, services provided, security transfers and capital contributions. Also, one segment may purchase annuity contracts from another to fund pension costs and to settle certain group life claims. In addition, certain inter-segment transactions occur that relate to interest income on allocated surplus. Consolidated net investment income is unaffected by such transactions.
The following table presents net income (loss) for each reporting segment, as well as the Corporate category.
 
Three Months Ended March 31,
Net income (loss)
2015
2014
Commercial Lines
$
240

$
242

Personal Lines
76

99

Property & Casualty Other Operations
23

22

Group Benefits
52

51

Mutual Funds
22

21

Talcott Resolution
111

145

Corporate
(57
)
(85
)
Net income
$
467

$
495


13

Table of Contents
THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)
3. Segment Information (continued)


The following table presents revenues by product line for each reporting segment, as well as the Corporate category.
 
Three Months Ended March 31,
Revenues
2015
2014
Earned premiums and fee income
 
 
Commercial Lines
 
 
Workers’ compensation
$
744

$
732

Property
156

136

Automobile
148

144

Package business
292

283

Liability
135

145

Bond
53

51

Professional liability
55

50

Total Commercial Lines
1,583

1,541

Personal Lines
 
 
Automobile
655

636

Homeowners
297

292

Total Personal Lines [1]
952

928

Group Benefits
 
 
Group disability
371

369

Group life
365

388

Other
44

42

Total Group Benefits
780

799

Mutual Funds
 
 
Mutual Fund
149

138

Talcott
30

36

Total Mutual Funds
179

174

Talcott Resolution
285

353

Corporate
2

3

Total earned premiums and fee income
3,781

3,798

Net investment income
809

824

Net realized capital gains
5

(35
)
Other revenues
22

25

Total revenues
$
4,617

$
4,612

[1]
For the three months ended March 31, 2015 and 2014, AARP members accounted for earned premiums of $766 and $736, respectively.

14

Table of Contents
THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)
4. Fair Value Measurements

Financial instruments carried at fair value in the Company's Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements include fixed maturity and equity securities, available-for-sale ("AFS"); fixed maturities at fair value using the fair value option ("FVO"); equity securities, FVO; short-term investments; freestanding and embedded derivatives; certain limited partnerships and other alternative investment; separate account assets and certain other liabilities.
The following section applies to the fair value hierarchy and disclosure requirements for the Company’s financial instruments that are carried at fair value. The fair value hierarchy prioritizes the inputs in the valuation techniques used to measure fair value into three broad Levels (Level 1, 2 or 3).
Level 1
Observable inputs that reflect quoted prices for identical assets, or liabilities, in active markets that the Company has the ability to access at the measurement date. Level 1 securities include highly liquid U.S. Treasuries, money market funds and exchange traded equity securities, open-ended mutual funds, and exchange-traded derivative instruments.
Level 2
Observable inputs, other than quoted prices included in Level 1, for the asset or liability, or prices for similar assets and liabilities. Most fixed maturities and preferred stocks, including those reported in separate account assets, are model priced by vendors using observable inputs and are classified within Level 2. Also included are hedge funds where investment company accounting guidance has been applied to a wholly-owned fund of funds measured at fair value where an investment can be redeemed, or substantially redeemed, at the net asset value per share or equivalent ("NAV") on the measurement date or in the near-term, not to exceed 90 days. Derivative instruments classified within Level 2 are priced using observable market inputs such as swap yield curves and credit default swap curves.
Level 3
Valuations that are derived from techniques in which one or more of the significant inputs are unobservable (including assumptions about risk). Level 3 securities include less liquid securities, guaranteed product embedded and reinsurance derivatives and other complex derivative instruments, as well as hedge fund investments carried at fair value, consistent with investment company accounting guidance, that cannot be redeemed in the near-term at the NAV. Because Level 3 fair values, by their nature, contain one or more significant unobservable inputs, as there is little or no observable market for these assets and liabilities, considerable judgment is used to determine the Level 3 fair values. Level 3 fair values represent the Company’s best estimate of an amount that could be realized in a current market exchange absent actual market exchanges.
In many situations, inputs used to measure the fair value of an asset or liability position may fall into different levels of the fair value hierarchy. In these situations, the Company will determine the level in which the fair value falls based upon the lowest level input that is significant to the determination of the fair value. Transfers of securities among the levels occur at the beginning of the reporting period. The amount of transfers from Level 1 to Level 2 was $106 and $1.3 billion, for the three months ended March 31, 2015 and 2014, respectively, which represented previously on-the-run U.S. Treasury securities that are now off-the-run. For the three months ended March 31, 2015 and 2014, there were no transfers from Level 2 to Level 1. In most cases, both observable (e.g., changes in interest rates) and unobservable (e.g., changes in risk assumptions) inputs are used in the determination of fair values that the Company has classified within Level 3. Consequently, these values and the related gains and losses are based upon both observable and unobservable inputs. The Company’s fixed maturities included in Level 3 are classified as such because these securities are primarily priced by independent brokers and/or within illiquid markets.

15

Table of Contents
THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)
4. Fair Value Measurements (continued)

The following tables present assets and (liabilities) carried at fair value by hierarchy level. These disclosures provide information as to the extent to which the Company uses fair value to measure financial instruments and information about the inputs used to value those financial instruments to allow users to assess the relative reliability of the measurements.
 
March 31, 2015
 
Total
Quoted Prices in
Active Markets
for Identical
Assets
(Level 1)
Significant
Observable
Inputs
(Level 2)
Significant
Unobservable
Inputs
(Level 3)
Assets accounted for at fair value on a recurring basis
 
 
 
 
Fixed maturities, AFS
 
 
 
 
Asset-backed-securities ("ABS")
$
3,004

$

$
2,843

$
161

Collateralized debt obligations ("CDOs")
2,982


2,398

584

Commercial mortgage-backed securities ("CMBS")
4,652


4,384

268

Corporate
27,119


26,007

1,112

Foreign government/government agencies
1,365


1,317

48

Municipal
12,842


12,778

64

Residential mortgage-backed securities ("RMBS")
4,078


2,615

1,463

U.S. Treasuries
4,513

444

4,069


Total fixed maturities
60,555

444

56,411

3,700

Fixed maturities, FVO
520


435

85

Equity securities, trading [1]
11

11



Equity securities, AFS
1,148

910

136

102

Derivative assets
 
 
 
 
Credit derivatives
9


13

(4
)
Commodity derivatives
7


7


Equity derivatives
2



2

Foreign exchange derivatives
9


9


Interest rate derivatives
130


119

11

Guaranteed minimum withdrawal benefit ("GMWB") hedging instruments
142


47

95

Macro hedge program
135



135

Other derivative contracts
11



11

Total derivative assets [2]
445


195

250

Short-term investments
3,651

313

3,338


Limited partnerships and other alternative investments [3]
742


552

190

Reinsurance recoverable for GMWB
65



65

Modified coinsurance reinsurance contracts
22


22


Separate account assets [4]
131,087

89,871

40,614

602

Total assets accounted for at fair value on a recurring basis
$
198,246

$
91,549

$
101,703

$
4,994

Liabilities accounted for at fair value on a recurring basis
 
 
 
 
Other policyholder funds and benefits payable
 
 
 
 
GMWB
$
(176
)
$

$

$
(176
)
Equity linked notes
(26
)


(26
)
Total other policyholder funds and benefits payable
(202
)


(202
)
Derivative liabilities
 
 
 
 
Credit derivatives
(6
)

1

(7
)
Commodity derivatives
3


3


Equity derivatives
32


26

6

Foreign exchange derivatives
(469
)

(469
)

Interest rate derivatives
(531
)

(502
)
(29
)
GMWB hedging instruments
39


(25
)
64

Macro hedge program
52



52

Total derivative liabilities [5]
(880
)

(966
)
86

Consumer notes [6]
(3
)


(3
)
Total liabilities accounted for at fair value on a recurring basis
$
(1,085
)
$

$
(966
)
$
(119
)

16

Table of Contents
THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)
4. Fair Value Measurements (continued)

 
December 31, 2014
 
Total
Quoted Prices in
Active Markets
for Identical
Assets
(Level 1)
Significant
Observable
Inputs
(Level 2)
Significant
Unobservable
Inputs
(Level 3)
Assets accounted for at fair value on a recurring basis
 
 
 
 
Fixed maturities, AFS
 
 
 
 
ABS
$
2,472

$

$
2,350

$
122

CDOs
2,841


2,218

623

CMBS
4,415


4,131

284

Corporate
27,359


26,319

1,040

Foreign government/government agencies
1,636


1,577

59

Municipal
12,871


12,805

66

RMBS
3,918


2,637

1,281

U.S. Treasuries
3,872

106

3,766


Total fixed maturities
59,384

106

55,803

3,475

Fixed maturities, FVO
488


396

92

Equity securities, trading [1]
11

11



Equity securities, AFS
1,047

786

163

98

Derivative assets
 
 
 
 
Credit derivatives
8


10

(2
)
Equity derivatives
3



3

Interest rate derivatives
129


113

16

GMWB hedging instruments
119


5

114

Macro hedge program
93



93

Other derivative contracts
12



12

Total derivative assets [2]
364


128

236

Short-term investments
4,883

349

4,534


Limited partnerships and other alternative investments [3]
770


581

189

Reinsurance recoverable for GMWB
56



56

Modified coinsurance reinsurance contracts
34


34


Separate account assets [4]
132,211

91,537

40,096

578

Total assets accounted for at fair value on a recurring basis
$
199,248

$
92,789

$
101,735

$
4,724

Liabilities accounted for at fair value on a recurring basis
 
 
 
 
Other policyholder funds and benefits payable
 
 
 
 
GMWB
$
(139
)
$

$

$
(139
)
Equity linked notes
(26
)


(26
)
Total other policyholder funds and benefits payable
(165
)


(165
)
Derivative liabilities
 
 
 
 
Credit derivatives
(16
)

(9
)
(7
)
Equity derivatives
28


25

3

Foreign exchange derivatives
(445
)

(445
)

Interest rate derivatives
(597
)

(574
)
(23
)
GMWB hedging instruments
55


(1
)
56

Macro hedge program
48



48

Total derivative liabilities [5]
(927
)

(1,004
)
77

Consumer notes [6]
(3
)


(3
)
Total liabilities accounted for at fair value on a recurring basis
$
(1,095
)
$

$
(1,004
)
$
(91
)

17

Table of Contents
THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)
4. Fair Value Measurements (continued)

[1]
Included in other investments on the Condensed Consolidated Balance Sheets.
[2]
Includes over-the-counter ("OTC") and OTC-cleared derivative instruments in a net positive fair value position after consideration of the accrued interest and impact of collateral posting requirements which may be imposed by agreements, clearing house rules and applicable law. As of March 31, 2015 and December 31, 2014, $389 and $413, respectively, of cash collateral liability was netted against the derivative asset value in the Condensed Consolidated Balance Sheets and is excluded from the preceding table. See the following footnote 4 for derivative liabilities.
[3]
Represents hedge funds where investment company accounting has been applied to a wholly-owned fund of funds measured at fair value.
[4]
Approximately $4.7 billion and $2.5 billion of investment sales receivable, as of March 31, 2015 and December 31, 2014, respectively, are excluded from this disclosure requirement because they are trade receivables in the ordinary course of business where the carrying amount approximates fair value.
[5]
Includes OTC and OTC-cleared derivative instruments in a net negative fair market value position (derivative liability) after consideration of the accrued interest and impact of collateral posting requirements which may be imposed by agreements, clearing house rules and applicable law. In the following Level 3 roll-forward table in this Note 4, the derivative assets and liabilities are referred to as “freestanding derivatives” and are presented on a net basis.
[6]
Represents embedded derivatives associated with non-funding agreement-backed consumer equity linked notes.
Determination of Fair Values
The valuation methodologies used to determine the fair values of assets and liabilities under the “exit price” notion, reflect market participant objectives and are based on the application of the fair value hierarchy that prioritizes relevant observable market inputs over unobservable inputs. The Company determines the fair values of certain financial assets and liabilities based on quoted market prices where available, and where prices represent a reasonable estimate of fair value. The Company also determines fair value based on future cash flows discounted at the appropriate current market rate. Fair values reflect adjustments for counterparty credit quality, the Company’s default spreads, liquidity, and where appropriate, risk margins on unobservable parameters. The following is a discussion of the methodologies used to determine fair values for the financial instruments listed in the preceding tables.
The fair value process is monitored by the Valuation Committee, which is a cross-functional group of senior management within the Company that meets at least quarterly. The Valuation Committee is co-chaired by the Heads of Investment Operations and Investment Accounting, and has representation from various investment sector professionals, accounting, operations, legal, compliance, and risk management. The purpose of the committee is to oversee the pricing policy and procedures by ensuring objective and reliable valuation practices and pricing of financial instruments, as well as addressing valuation issues and approving changes to valuation methodologies and pricing sources. There are also two working groups under the Valuation Committee, a Securities Fair Value Working Group (“Securities Working Group”) and a Derivatives Fair Value Working Group ("Derivatives Working Group"), which include various investment, operations, accounting and risk management professionals that meet monthly to review market data trends, pricing and trading statistics and results, and any proposed pricing methodology changes.
The Company also has an enterprise-wide Operational Risk Management function, led by the Chief Operational Risk Officer, which is responsible for establishing, maintaining and communicating the framework, principles and guidelines of the Company's operational risk management program. This includes model risk management which provides an independent review of the suitability, characteristics and reliability of model inputs, as well as an analysis of significant changes to current models.
Fixed Maturities, AFS; Fixed Maturities, FVO; Equity Securities, AFS; Equity Securities, FVO; and Short-term Investments
The fair value of AFS and FVO securities,and short-term investments in an active and orderly market (e.g. not distressed or forced liquidation) are determined by management after considering the following primary sources of information: quoted prices for identical assets or liabilities, third-party pricing services, independent broker quotations, or pricing matrices. Security pricing is applied using a “waterfall” approach whereby publicly available prices are first sought from third-party pricing services, and the remaining unpriced securities are submitted to independent brokers for prices, or priced using a pricing matrix. Typical inputs used by these pricing methods include, but are not limited to, reported trades, benchmark yields, issuer spreads, bids, offers, and/or estimated cash flows, prepayment speeds, and default rates. Based on the typical trading volumes and the lack of quoted market prices for fixed maturities, third-party pricing services will normally derive the security prices from recent reported trades for identical or similar securities making adjustments through the reporting date based upon the preceding outlined available market observable information. If there are no recently reported trades, the third-party pricing services and independent brokers may use matrix or model processes to develop a security price where future cash flow expectations are developed based upon collateral performance and discounted at an estimated market rate. Included in the pricing of ABS and RMBS are estimates of the rate of future prepayments of principal over the remaining life of the securities. Such estimates are derived based on the characteristics of the underlying structure and prepayment speeds previously experienced at the interest rate levels projected for the underlying collateral. Actual prepayment experience may vary from these estimates.
Prices from third-party pricing services are often unavailable for securities that are rarely traded or are traded only in privately negotiated transactions. As a result, certain securities are priced via independent broker quotations which utilize inputs that may be difficult to corroborate with observable market based data. Additionally, the majority of these independent broker quotations are non-binding.

18

Table of Contents
THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)
4. Fair Value Measurements (continued)

Private placement securities are priced using a pricing matrix to determine the credit spreads that are used to discount the expected future cash flows for securities for which the Company is unable to obtain a price from a third-party pricing service. Credit spreads are developed each month using market based data for public securities adjusted for credit spread differentials between public and private securities which are obtained from a survey of multiple private placement brokers. The appropriate credit spreads determined through this survey approach are based upon the issuer’s financial strength and term to maturity, utilizing an independent public security index and trade information and adjusting for the non-public nature of the securities.
The Securities Working Group performs ongoing analysis of the prices and credit spreads received from third parties to ensure that the prices represent a reasonable estimate of the fair value. This process involves quantitative and qualitative analysis and is overseen by investment and accounting professionals. As a part of this analysis, the Company considers trading volume, new issuance activity and other factors to determine whether the market activity is significantly different than normal activity in an active market, and if so, whether transactions may not be orderly considering the weight of available evidence. If the available evidence indicates that pricing is based upon transactions that are stale or not orderly, the Company places little, if any, weight on the transaction price and will estimate fair value utilizing an internal pricing model. In addition, the Company ensures that prices received from independent brokers represent a reasonable estimate of fair value through the use of internal and external cash flow models developed based on spreads, and when available, market indices. As a result of this analysis, if the Company determines that there is a more appropriate fair value based upon the available market data, the price received from the third party is adjusted accordingly and approved by the Valuation Committee. The Company’s internal pricing model utilizes the Company’s best estimate of expected future cash flows discounted at a rate of return that a market participant would require. The significant inputs to the model include, but are not limited to, current market inputs, such as credit loss assumptions, estimated prepayment speeds and market risk premiums.
The Company conducts other specific monitoring controls around pricing. Daily analyses identify price changes over 3% for fixed maturities and 5% for equity securities and trade prices that differ over 3% to the current day’s price. Weekly analyses identify prices that differ more than 5% from published bond prices of a corporate bond index. Monthly analyses identify price changes over 3%, prices that have not changed, and missing prices. Also on a monthly basis, a second source validation is performed on most sectors. Analyses are conducted by a dedicated pricing unit that follows up with trading and investment sector professionals and challenges prices with vendors when the estimated assumptions used differ from what the Company feels a market participant would use. Any changes from the identified pricing source are verified by further confirmation of assumptions used. Examples of other procedures performed include, but are not limited to, initial and on-going review of third-party pricing services’ methodologies, review of pricing statistics and trends, and back testing recent trades.
The Company has analyzed the third-party pricing services’ valuation methodologies and related inputs, and has also evaluated the various types of securities in its investment portfolio to determine an appropriate fair value hierarchy level based upon trading activity and the observability of market inputs. Most prices provided by third-party pricing services are classified into Level 2 because the inputs used in pricing the securities are market observable. Due to a general lack of transparency in the process that brokers use to develop prices, most valuations that are based on brokers’ prices are classified as Level 3. Some valuations may be classified as Level 2 if the price can be corroborated with observable market data.
Derivative Instruments, including embedded derivatives within investments
Derivative instruments are fair valued using pricing valuation models that utilize independent market data inputs for OTC derivatives, quoted market prices for exchange-traded and OTC-cleared derivatives, or independent broker quotations. Excluding embedded and reinsurance related derivatives, as of March 31, 2015 and December 31, 2014, 96% and 96%, respectively, of derivatives, based upon notional values, were priced by valuation models or quoted market prices. The remaining derivatives were priced by broker quotations.
The Derivatives Working Group performs ongoing analysis of the valuations, assumptions and methodologies used to ensure that the prices represent a reasonable estimate of the fair value. This process involves quantitative and qualitative analysis and is overseen by investment and accounting professionals. The Company performs various controls on derivative valuations which include both quantitative and qualitative analysis. Analyses are conducted by a dedicated derivative pricing team that works directly with investment sector professionals to analyze impacts of changes in the market environment and investigate variances. There is a monthly analysis to identify market value changes greater than pre-defined thresholds, stale prices, missing prices, and zero prices. Also on a monthly basis, a second source validation, typically to broker quotations, is performed for certain of the more complex derivatives, as well as for any existing deals with a market value greater than $10 and all new deals during the month. In addition, on a daily basis, market valuations are compared to counterparty valuations for OTC derivatives. A model validation review is performed on any new models, which typically includes detailed documentation and validation to a second source. The model validation documentation and results of validation are presented to the Valuation Committee for approval. There is a monthly control to review changes in pricing sources to ensure that new models are not moved to production until formally approved.

19

Table of Contents
THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)
4. Fair Value Measurements (continued)

The Company utilizes derivative instruments to manage the risk associated with certain assets and liabilities. However, the derivative instrument may not be classified with the same fair value hierarchy level as the associated assets and liabilities. Therefore, the realized and unrealized gains and losses on derivatives reported in the Level 3 rollforward may not reflect the offsetting impact of the realized and unrealized gains and losses of the associated assets and liabilities.
Limited partnerships and other alternative investments
A portion of limited partnerships and other alternative investments include hedge funds where investment company accounting has been applied to a wholly-owned fund of funds measured at fair value. Fair value is determined for these funds using the NAV, as a practical expedient, calculated on a monthly basis, and is the amount at which a unit or shareholder may redeem their investment, if redemption is allowed. Certain impediments to redemption include, but are not limited to the following: 1) redemption notice periods vary and may be as long as 90 days, 2) redemption may be restricted (e.g. only be allowed on a quarter-end), 3) a holding period referred to as a lock-up may be imposed whereby an investor must hold their investment for a specified period of time before they can make a notice for redemption, 4) gating provisions may limit all redemptions in a given period to a percentage of the entities' equity interests, or may only allow an investor to redeem a portion of their investment at one time and 5) early redemption penalties may be imposed that are expressed as a percentage of the amount redeemed. The Company regularly assesses impediments to redemption and current market conditions that will restrict the redemption at the end of the notice period. Any funds that are subject to significant liquidity restrictions are reported in Level 3; all others are classified as Level 2.
Valuation Techniques and Inputs for Investments
Generally, the Company determines the estimated fair value of its AFS and FVO securities, equity securities, trading, and short-term investments using the market approach. The income approach is used for securities priced using a pricing matrix, as well as for derivative instruments. Certain limited partnerships and other alternative investments are measured at fair value using a NAV as a practical expedient. For Level 1 investments, which are comprised of on-the-run U.S. Treasuries, exchange-traded equity securities, short-term investments, and exchange traded futures and option contracts, valuations are based on observable inputs that reflect quoted prices for identical assets in active markets that the Company has the ability to access at the measurement date.
For most of the Company’s debt securities, the following inputs are typically used in the Company’s pricing methods: reported trades, benchmark yields, bids and/or estimated cash flows. For securities, except U.S. Treasuries, inputs also include issuer spreads which may consider credit default swaps. Derivative instruments are valued using mid-market inputs that are predominantly observable in the market.

20

Table of Contents
THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)
4. Fair Value Measurements (continued)

A description of additional inputs used in the Company’s Level 2 and Level 3 measurements is included in the following discussion:
Level 2
The fair values of most of the Company’s Level 2 investments are determined by management after considering prices received from third party pricing services. These investments include most fixed maturities and preferred stocks, including those reported in separate account assets, as well as, hedge funds where investment company accounting has been applied to a wholly-owned fund of funds measured at fair value, and derivative instruments.
ABS, CDOs, CMBS and RMBS – Primary inputs also include monthly payment information, collateral performance, which varies by vintage year and includes delinquency rates, collateral valuation loss severity rates, collateral refinancing assumptions, credit default swap indices and, for ABS and RMBS, estimated prepayment rates.
Corporates, including investment grade private placements – Primary inputs also include observations of credit default swap curves related to the issuer.
Foreign government/government agencies — Primary inputs also include observations of credit default swap curves related to the issuer and political events in emerging market economies.
Municipals – Primary inputs also include Municipal Securities Rulemaking Board reported trades and material event notices, and issuer financial statements.
Short-term investments – Primary inputs also include material event notices and new issue money market rates.
Credit derivatives – Primary inputs include the swap yield curve and credit default swap curves.
Commodity derivatives – Primary input is the underlying commodity price curves.
Foreign exchange derivatives – Primary inputs include the swap yield curve, currency spot and forward rates, and cross currency basis curves.
Interest rate derivatives – Primary input is the swap yield curve.
Limited partnerships and other alternative investments — Primary inputs include a NAV for investment companies with no redemption restrictions as reported on their U.S. GAAP financial statements, which are typically recorded on a one-month lag.
Level 3
Most of the Company’s securities classified as Level 3 include less liquid securities such as lower quality ABS, CMBS, commercial real estate (“CRE”) CDOs and RMBS primarily backed by sub-prime loans. Securities included in Level 3 are primarily valued based on broker prices or broker spreads, without adjustments. Primary inputs for non-broker priced investments, including structured securities, are consistent with the typical inputs used in the preceding noted Level 2 measurements, but are Level 3 due to their less liquid markets. Additionally, certain long-dated securities are priced based on third party pricing services, including certain municipal securities, foreign government/government agencies, and bank loans. Primary inputs for these long-dated securities are consistent with the typical inputs used in the preceding noted Level 1 and Level 2 measurements, but include benchmark interest rate or credit spread assumptions that are not observable in the marketplace. Level 3 investments also include below investment grade private placements, as well as hedge funds where investment company accounting has been applied to a wholly-owned fund of funds measured at fair value where the Company does not have the ability to redeem the investment in the near-term at the NAV. Also included in Level 3 are certain derivative instruments that either have significant unobservable inputs or are valued based on broker quotations. Significant inputs for these derivative contracts primarily include the typical inputs used in the preceding noted Level 1 and Level 2 measurements; but also include equity and interest rate volatility and swap yield curves beyond observable limits.

21

Table of Contents
THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)
4. Fair Value Measurements (continued)

Significant Unobservable Inputs for Level 3 Assets Measured at Fair Value
The following tables present information about significant unobservable inputs used in Level 3 assets measured at fair value. The tables exclude securities such as ABS and CRE CDOs for which fair values are predominately based on broker quotations.
Securities
Unobservable Inputs

As of March 31, 2015
Assets accounted for at fair value on a recurring basis
Fair
Value
Predominant
Valuation
Method
Significant
Unobservable Input
Minimum
Maximum
Weighted Average [1]
Impact of
Increase in Input
on Fair Value [2]
CMBS
$
268

Discounted cash flows
Spread (encompasses prepayment, default risk and loss severity)
43
 bps
2,474
 bps
267
 bps
Decrease
Corporate [3]
640

Discounted cash flows
Spread
120
 bps
1,652
 bps
327
 bps
Decrease
Municipal [3]
33

Discounted cash flows
Spread
214
 bps
214
 bps
214
 bps
Decrease
RMBS
1,463

Discounted cash flows
Spread
24
 bps
1,693
 bps
155
 bps
Decrease
 
 
 
Constant prepayment rate
%
8.0
%
3.0
%
 Decrease [4]
 
 
 
Constant default rate
1.0
%
14.0
%
7.0
%
Decrease
 
 
 
Loss severity
%
100.0
%
79.0
%
Decrease
 
As of December 31, 2014
CMBS
$
284

Discounted cash flows
Spread (encompasses prepayment, default risk and loss severity)
46
 bps
2,475
 bps
284
 bps
Decrease
Corporate [3]
568

Discounted cash flows
Spread
123
 bps
765
 bps
279
 bps
Decrease
Municipal [3]
32

Discounted cash flows
Spread
212
 bps
212
 bps
212
 bps
Decrease
RMBS
1,281

Discounted cash flows
Spread
23
 bps
1,904
 bps
142
 bps
Decrease
 
 
 
Constant prepayment rate
%
7.0
%
2.0
%
Decrease [4]
 
 
 
Constant default rate
1.0
%
14.0
%
7.0
%
Decrease
 
 
 
Loss severity
%
100.0
%
78.0
%
Decrease
[1]
The weighted average is determined based on the fair value of the securities.
[2]
Conversely, the impact of a decrease in input would have the opposite impact to the fair value as that presented in the preceding table.
[3]
Level 3 corporate and municipal securities excludes those for which the Company bases fair value on broker quotations as noted in the following discussion.
[4]
Decrease for above market rate coupons and increase for below market rate coupons.

22

Table of Contents
THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)
4. Fair Value Measurements (continued)

Freestanding Derivatives
Unobservable Inputs

As of March 31, 2015
 
Fair
Value
Predominant
Valuation 
Method
Significant Unobservable Input
Minimum
Maximum
Impact of 
Increase in Input on 
Fair Value [1]
Interest rate derivative
 
 
 
 
 
 
Interest rate swaps
(30
)
Discounted cash flows
Swap curve beyond 30 years
2
%
2
%
Decrease
Interest rate swaptions
12

Option model
Interest rate volatility
1
%
1
%
Increase
GMWB hedging instruments
 
 
 
 
 
 
Equity options
15

Option model
Equity volatility
23
%
38
%
Increase
Customized swaps
144

Discounted cash flows
Equity volatility
10
%
40
%
Increase
Macro hedge program
 
 
 
 
 
 
Equity options
187

Option model
Equity volatility
16
%
30
%
Increase
 
As of December 31, 2014
Interest rate derivative
 
 
 
 
 
 
Interest rate swaps
(29
)
Discounted cash flows
Swap curve beyond 30 years
3
%
3
%
Decrease
Interest rate swaptions
22

Option model
Interest rate volatility
1
%
1
%
Increase
GMWB hedging instruments
 
 
 
 
 
 
Equity options
46

Option model
Equity volatility
22
%
34
%
Increase
Customized swaps
124

Discounted cash flows
Equity volatility
10
%
40
%
Increase
Macro hedge program
 
 
 
 
 
 
Equity options
141

Option model
Equity volatility
27
%
28
%
Increase
[1]
Conversely, the impact of a decrease in input would have the opposite impact to the fair value as that presented in the table. Changes are based on long positions, unless otherwise noted. Changes in fair value will be inversely impacted for short positions.
Securities and derivatives for which the Company bases fair value on broker quotations predominately include ABS, CDOs, corporate, fixed maturities, FVO. Due to the lack of transparency in the process brokers use to develop prices for these investments, the Company does not have access to the significant unobservable inputs brokers use to price these securities and derivatives. The Company believes however, the types of inputs brokers may use would likely be similar to those used to price securities and derivatives for which inputs are available to the Company, and therefore may include but not be limited to, loss severity rates, constant prepayment rates, constant default rates and credit spreads. Therefore, similar to non broker priced securities and derivatives, generally, increases in these inputs would cause fair values to decrease. For the three months ended March 31, 2015, no significant adjustments were made by the Company to broker prices received.
As of March 31, 2015 and December 31, 2014, excluded from the preceding tables are hedge funds where investment company accounting has been applied to a wholly-owned fund of funds measured at fair value which total $190 and $189, respectively, of Level 3 assets. The predominant valuation method uses a NAV calculated on a monthly basis and represents funds where the Company does not have the ability to redeem the investment in the near-term at that NAV, including an assessment of the investee's liquidity.
Product Derivatives
The Company formerly offered certain variable annuity products with GMWB riders. The GMWB provides the policyholder with a guaranteed remaining balance (“GRB”) which is generally equal to premiums less withdrawals.  If the policyholder’s account value is reduced to the specified level through a combination of market declines and withdrawals but the GRB still has value, the Company is obligated to continue to make annuity payments to the policyholder until the GRB is exhausted. Certain contract provisions can increase the GRB at contractholder election or after the passage of time. The GMWB represents an embedded derivative in the variable annuity contract. When it is determined that (1) the embedded derivative possesses economic characteristics that are not clearly and closely related to the economic characteristics of the host contract, and (2) a separate instrument with the same terms would qualify as a derivative instrument, the embedded derivative is bifurcated from the host for measurement purposes. The embedded derivative is carried at fair value, with changes in fair value reported in net realized capital gains and losses. The Company’s GMWB liability is reported in other policyholder funds and benefits payable in the Condensed Consolidated Balance Sheets. The notional value of the embedded derivative is the GRB.

23

Table of Contents
THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)
4. Fair Value Measurements (continued)

In valuing the embedded derivative, the Company attributes to the derivative a portion of the expected fees to be collected over the expected life of the contract from the contract holder equal to the present value of future GMWB claims. The excess of fees collected from the contract holder in the current period over the current period’s attributed fees are associated with the host variable annuity contract and reported in fee income.
GMWB Reinsurance Derivative
The Company has reinsurance arrangements in place to transfer a portion of its risk of loss due to GMWB. These arrangements are recognized as derivatives and carried at fair value in reinsurance recoverables. Changes in the fair value of the reinsurance agreements are reported in net realized capital gains and losses.
The fair value of the GMWB reinsurance derivative is calculated as an aggregation of the components described in the following Living Benefits Required to be Fair Valued discussion and is modeled using significant unobservable policyholder behavior inputs, identical to those used in calculating the underlying liability, such as lapses, fund selection, resets and withdrawal utilization and risk margins.
Living Benefits Required to be Fair Valued (in Other Policyholder Funds and Benefits Payable)
Fair values for GMWBs classified as embedded derivatives are calculated using the income approach based upon internally developed models because active, observable markets do not exist for those items. The fair value of these GMWBs and the related reinsurance and customized freestanding derivatives are calculated as an aggregation of the following components: Best Estimate Claim Payments; Credit Standing Adjustment; and Margins. The resulting aggregation is reconciled or calibrated, if necessary, to market information that is, or may be, available to the Company, but may not be observable by other market participants, including reinsurance discussions and transactions. The Company believes the aggregation of these components, as necessary and as reconciled or calibrated to the market information available to the Company, results in an amount that the Company would be required to transfer or receive, for an asset, to or from market participants in an active liquid market, if one existed, for those market participants to assume the risks associated with the guaranteed minimum benefits and the related reinsurance and customized derivatives. The fair value is likely to materially diverge from the ultimate settlement of the liability as the Company believes settlement will be based on our best estimate assumptions rather than those best estimate assumptions plus risk margins. In the absence of any transfer of the guaranteed benefit liability to a third party, the release of risk margins is likely to be reflected as realized gains in future periods’ net income. Each component described in the following discussion is unobservable in the marketplace and requires subjectivity by the Company in determining its value. Oversight of the Company's valuation policies and processes for product and GMWB reinsurance derivatives is performed by a multidisciplinary group comprised of finance, actuarial and risk management professionals. This multidisciplinary group reviews and approves changes and enhancements to the Company's valuation model as well as associated controls.
Best Estimate
Claim Payments
The Best Estimate Claim Payments are calculated based on actuarial and capital market assumptions related to projected cash flows, including the present value of benefits and related contract charges, over the lives of the contracts, incorporating expectations concerning policyholder behavior such as lapses, fund selection, resets and withdrawal utilization. For the customized derivatives, policyholder behavior is prescribed in the derivative contract. Because of the dynamic and complex nature of these cash flows, best estimate assumptions and a Monte Carlo stochastic process is used in valuation. The Monte Carlo stochastic process involves the generation of thousands of scenarios that assume risk neutral returns consistent with swap rates and a blend of observable implied index volatility levels. Estimating these cash flows involves numerous estimates and subjective judgments regarding a number of variables. These variables include expected market rates of return, market volatility, correlations of market index returns to funds, fund performance, discount rates and assumptions about policyholder behavior which emerge over time.
At each valuation date, the Company assumes expected returns based on:
risk-free rates as represented by the Eurodollar futures, LIBOR deposits and swap rates to derive forward curve rates;
market implied volatility assumptions for each underlying index based primarily on a blend of observed market “implied volatility” data;
correlations of historical returns across underlying well known market indices based on actual observed returns over the ten years preceding the valuation date; and
three years of history for fund indexes compared to separate account fund regression.

24

Table of Contents
THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)
4. Fair Value Measurements (continued)

On a daily basis, the Company updates capital market assumptions used in the GMWB liability model such as interest rates, equity indices and the blend of implied equity index volatilities. The Company monitors various aspects of policyholder behavior and may modify certain of its assumptions, including living benefit lapses and withdrawal rates, if credible emerging data indicates that changes are warranted. In addition, the Company will continue to evaluate policyholder behavior assumptions as we implement initiatives to reduce the size of the variable annuity business. At a minimum, all policyholder behavior assumptions are reviewed and updated, as appropriate, in conjunction with the completion of the Company’s annual comprehensive study to refine its estimate of future gross profits.
Credit Standing Adjustment
This assumption makes an adjustment that market participants would make, in determining fair value, to reflect the risk that guaranteed benefit obligations, or the GMWB reinsurance recoverables will not be fulfilled. The Company incorporates a blend of observable Company and reinsurer credit default spreads from capital markets, adjusted for market recoverability. The credit standing adjustment assumption, net of reinsurance, resulted in pre-tax realized gains (losses) of $0 and $(1), for the three months ended March 31, 2015 and 2014, respectively. As of March 31, 2015 and December 31, 2014 the credit standing adjustment was $2 and $1, respectively.
Margins
The behavior risk margin adds a margin that market participants would require, in determining fair value, for the risk that the Company’s assumptions about policyholder behavior could differ from actual experience. The behavior risk margin is calculated by taking the difference between adverse policyholder behavior assumptions and best estimate assumptions.
There were no policyholder assumption updates for the three months ended March 31, 2015 and 2014. As of March 31, 2015 and December 31, 2014 the behavior risk margin was $69 and $74, respectively.
In addition to the non-market-based update described in the preceding discussion, the Company recognized non-market-based updates driven by the relative outperformance (underperformance) of the underlying actively managed funds as compared to their respective indices resulting in pre-tax realized gains (losses) of approximately $10 and $14, for the three months ended March 31, 2015 and 2014.
Significant unobservable inputs used in the fair value measurement the GMWB embedded derivative and the GMWB reinsurance derivative are withdrawal utilization and withdrawal rates, lapse rates, reset elections and equity volatility. The following table provides quantitative information about the significant unobservable inputs and is applicable to all of the GMWB embedded derivative and the GMWB reinsurance derivative. Significant increases in any of the significant unobservable inputs, in isolation, will generally have an increase or decrease correlation with the fair value measurement, as shown in the table.
Significant Unobservable Input
Unobservable Inputs (Minimum)
Unobservable Inputs (Maximum)
Impact of Increase in Input
on Fair Value Measurement [1]
Withdrawal Utilization [2]
20%
100%
Increase
Withdrawal Rates [3]
—%
8%
Increase
Lapse Rates [4]
—%
75%
Decrease
Reset Elections [5]
20%
75%
Increase
Equity Volatility [6]
10%
40%
Increase
[1]
Conversely, the impact of a decrease in input would have the opposite impact to the fair value as that presented in the table.
[2]
Range represents assumed cumulative percentages of policyholders taking withdrawals.
[3]
Range represents assumed cumulative annual amount withdrawn by policyholders.
[4]
Range represents assumed annual percentages of full surrender of the underlying variable annuity contracts across all policy durations for in force business.
[5]
Range represents assumed cumulative percentages of policyholders that would elect to reset their guaranteed benefit base.
[6]
Range represents implied market volatilities for equity indices based on multiple pricing sources.
Generally, a change in withdrawal utilization assumptions would be accompanied by a directionally opposite change in lapse rate assumptions, as the behavior of policyholders that utilize GMWB riders is typically different from policyholders that do not utilize these riders.
Separate Account Assets
Separate account assets are primarily invested in mutual funds. Other separate account assets include fixed maturities, limited partnerships, equity securities, short-term investments, and derivatives that are valued in the same manner, and using the same pricing sources and inputs, as those investments held by the Company. Separate account assets classified as Level 3 primarily include limited partnerships in which fair value represents the separate account’s share of the fair value of the equity in the investment (“net asset value”) and are classified in Level 3, based on the Company’s ability to redeem its investment.

25

Table of Contents
THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)
4. Fair Value Measurements (continued)

Assets and Liabilities Measured at Fair Value on a Recurring Basis Using Significant Unobservable Inputs (Level 3)
The following tables provide fair value roll-forwards for the three months ended March 31, 2015 and 2014, for the financial instruments classified as Level 3.
For the three months ended March 31, 2015
 
Fixed Maturities, AFS
 
Assets
ABS
CDOs
CMBS
Corporate
Foreign
govt./govt.
agencies
Municipal
RMBS
Total  Fixed
Maturities,
AFS
Fixed
Maturities,
FVO
Fair value as of January 1, 2015
$
122

$
623

$
284

$
1,040

$
59

$
66

$
1,281

$
3,475

$
92

Total realized/unrealized gains (losses)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Included in net income [1] [2] [6]

(2
)
(1
)
(4
)


(1
)
(8
)
(5
)
Included in OCI [3]

19

(3
)
(28
)
1

(2
)
(1
)
(14
)

Purchases
43


21

5

5


310

384

12

Settlements
(1
)
(9
)
(13
)
1

(1
)

(46
)
(69
)

Sales



(7
)
(16
)

(31
)
(54
)
(4
)
Transfers into Level 3 [4]
1


5

139



4

149


Transfers out of Level 3 [4]
(4
)
(47
)
(25
)
(34
)


(53
)
(163
)
(10
)
Fair value as of March 31, 2015
$
161

$
584

$
268

$
1,112

$
48

$
64

$
1,463

$
3,700

$
85

Changes in unrealized gains (losses) included in net income related to financial instruments still held at March 31, 2015 [2] [7]
$

$
(1
)
$
(1
)
$
(2
)
$

$

$
(1
)
$
(5
)
$
(1
)
 
 
Freestanding Derivatives [5]
Assets (Liabilities)
Equity
Securities,
AFS
Credit
Equity
Interest
Rate
GMWB
Hedging
Macro
Hedge
Program
Other
Contracts
Total Free-
Standing
Derivatives [5]
Fair value as of January 1, 2015
$
98

$
(9
)
$
6

$
(7
)
$
170

$
141

$
12

$
313

Total realized/unrealized gains (losses)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Included in net income [1], [2], [6]
1

5

17

(11
)
9

(1
)
(1
)
18

Included in OCI [3]
(3
)







Purchases
8

(7
)



47


40

Settlements


(15
)

(20
)


(35
)
Sales
(2
)







Transfers into Level 3 [4]








Transfers out of Level 3 [4]








Fair value as of March 31, 2015
$
102

$
(11
)
$
8

$
(18
)
$
159

$
187

$
11

$
336

Changes in unrealized gains (losses) included in net income related to financial instruments still held at March 31, 2015 [2] [7]
$
1

$
5

$
3

$
(19
)
$
16

$
3

$
(1
)
$
7


26

Table of Contents
THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)
4. Fair Value Measurements (continued)

Assets
Limited Partnerships and Other Alternative Investments
Reinsurance Recoverable for GMWB
Separate Accounts
Fair value as of January 1, 2015
$
189

$
56

$
578

Total realized/unrealized gains (losses)
 
 
 
Included in net income [1] [2] [6]
1

4


Purchases


38

Settlements

5

(5
)
Sales


(6
)
Transfers into Level 3 [4]


1

Transfers out of Level 3 [4]


(4
)
Fair value as of March 31, 2015
$
190

$
65

$
602

Changes in unrealized gains (losses) included in net income related to financial instruments still held at March 31, 2015 [2] [7]
$
1

$
4

$

 
Other Policyholder Funds and Benefits Payable
 
Liabilities
Guaranteed Withdrawal Benefits
Equity Linked Notes
Total Other Policyholder Funds and Benefits Payable
Consumer Notes
Fair value as of January 1, 2015
$
(139
)
$
(26
)
$
(165
)
$
(3
)
Total realized/unrealized gains (losses)
 
 
 
 
Included in net income [1] [2] [6]
(19
)

(19
)

Settlements
(18
)

(18
)

Fair value as of March 31, 2015
$
(176
)
$
(26
)
$
(202
)
$
(3
)
Changes in unrealized gains (losses) included in net income related to financial instruments still held at March 31, 2015 [2] [7]
$
(19
)
$

$
(19
)
$

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 

27

Table of Contents
THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)
4. Fair Value Measurements (continued)

For the three months ended March 31, 2014
 
Fixed Maturities, AFS
 
Assets
ABS
CDOs
CMBS
Corporate
Foreign
govt./govt.
agencies
Municipal
RMBS
Total  Fixed
Maturities,
AFS
Fixed
Maturities,
FVO
Fair value as of January 1, 2014
$
147

$
664

$
663

$
1,274

$
65

$
69

$
1,272

$
4,154

$
193

Total realized/unrealized gains (losses)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Included in net income [1] [2] [6]


23

(14
)
(2
)

(1
)
6

10

Included in OCI [3]
2


(22
)
24

5

3

14

26


Purchases


65

37


12

147

261

5

Settlements
(1
)
(14
)
(33
)
1

(1
)

(46
)
(94
)

Sales


(87
)
(78
)
(13
)

(42
)
(220
)
(2
)
Transfers into Level 3 [4]

72


67




139

1

Transfers out of Level 3 [4]
(92
)
(10
)
(17
)
(68
)

(6
)
(16
)
(209
)
(1
)
Fair value as of March 31, 2014
$
56

$
712

$
592

$
1,243

$
54

$
78

$
1,328

$
4,063

$
206

Changes in unrealized gains (losses) included in net income related to financial instruments still held at March 31, 2014 [2] [7]
$

$

$
8

$
(17
)
$
(2
)
$

$

$
(11
)
$
10

 
 
Freestanding Derivatives [5]
Assets (Liabilities)
Equity
Securities,
AFS
Credit
Equity
Interest
Rate
GMWB
Hedging
Macro
Hedge
Program
Intl.
Program
Hedging
Other
Contracts
Total Free-
Standing
Derivatives [5]
Fair value as of January 1, 2014
$
77

$
2

$
3

$
18

$
146

$
139

$
(29
)
$
17

$
296

Total realized/unrealized gains (losses)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Included in net income [1], [2], [6]
(2
)
(2
)
(1
)
(14
)
(34
)
(10
)
15

(1
)
(47
)
Included in OCI [3]
4









Purchases




4

4

9


17

Settlements




7




7

Transfers out of Level 3 [4]



24





24

Fair value as of March 31, 2014
$
79

$

$
2

$
28

$
123

$
133

$
(5
)
$
16

$
297

Changes in unrealized gains (losses) included in net income related to financial instruments still held at March 31, 2014 [2] [7]
$
(2
)
$
(1
)
$

$
(16
)
$
(50
)
$
(10
)
$
17

$

$
(60
)

28

Table of Contents
THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)
4. Fair Value Measurements (continued)

Assets
Limited Partnerships and Other Alternative Investments
Reinsurance Recoverable for GMWB
Separate Accounts
Fair value as of January 1, 2014
$
108

$
29

$
737

Total realized/unrealized gains (losses)
 
 
 
Included in net income [1] [2] [6]
3

(4
)
5

Purchases
30


130

Settlements

5

(1
)
Sales
(24
)

(86
)
Transfers into Level 3 [4]


3

Transfers out of Level 3 [4]
(10
)

(26
)
Fair value as of March 31, 2014
$
107

$
30

$
762

Changes in unrealized gains (losses) included in net income related to financial instruments still held at March 31, 2014 [2] [7]
$
3

$
(4
)
$
5

 
Other Policyholder Funds and Benefits Payable
 
Liabilities
Guaranteed
Withdrawal
Benefits
International Guaranteed
Living
Benefits
International Other Living
Benefits
Equity
Linked
Notes
Total Other
Policyholder
Funds and
Benefits
Payable
Consumer
Notes
Fair value as of January 1, 2014
$
(36
)
$
3

$
3

$
(18
)
$
(48
)
$
(2
)
Total realized/unrealized gains (losses)
 
 
 
 
 
 
Included in net income [1] [2] [6]
36


(1
)
(1
)
34


Settlements
(24
)
(1
)


(25
)

Fair value as of March 31, 2014
$
(24
)
$
2

$
2

$
(19
)
$
(39
)
$
(2
)
Changes in unrealized gains (losses) included in net income related to financial instruments still held at March 31, 2014 [2] [7]
$
36

$

$
(1
)
$
(1
)
$
34

$

[1]
The Company classifies gains and losses on GMWB reinsurance derivatives and GMWB embedded derivatives as unrealized gains (losses) for purposes of disclosure in this table because it is impracticable to track on a contract-by-contract basis the realized gains (losses) for these derivatives and embedded derivatives.
[2]
All amounts in these rows are reported in net realized capital gains (losses). The realized/unrealized gains (losses) included in net income for separate account assets are offset by an equal amount for separate account liabilities, which results in a net zero impact on net income for the Company. All amounts are before income taxes and amortization of DAC.
[3]
All amounts are before income taxes and amortization of DAC.
[4]
Transfers in and/or (out) of Level 3 are primarily attributable to the availability of market observable information and the re-evaluation of the observability of pricing inputs.
[5]
Derivative instruments are reported in this table on a net basis for asset (liability) positions and reported in the Condensed Consolidated Balance Sheets in other investments and other liabilities.
[6]
Includes both market and non-market impacts in deriving realized and unrealized gains (losses).
[7]
Amounts presented are for Level 3 only and therefore may not agree to other disclosures included herein.
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 

29

Table of Contents
THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)
4. Fair Value Measurements (continued)

Fair Value Option
The Company elected the fair value option for certain equity securities in order to align the accounting with total return swap contracts that hedge the risk associated with the investments. The swaps do not qualify for hedge accounting and the change in value of both the equity securities and the total return swaps are recorded in net realized capital gains and losses. These equity securities are classified within equity securities, AFS on the Condensed Consolidated Balance Sheets. Income earned from FVO securities is recorded in net investment income and changes in fair value are recorded in net realized capital gains and losses.
FVO investments also include certain securities that contain embedded credit derivatives with underlying credit risk primarily related to residential and commercial real estate, for which the company has elected the fair value option.
The Company also classifies the underlying fixed maturities held in certain consolidated investment funds within the Fixed Maturities, FVO line on the Condensed Consolidated Balance Sheets. The Company reports consolidated investment companies at fair value with changes in the fair value of these securities recognized in net realized capital gains and losses, which is consistent with accounting requirements for investment companies. The investment funds hold fixed income securities in multiple sectors and the Company has management and control of the funds as well as a significant ownership interest.
The following table presents the changes in fair value of those assets and liabilities accounted for using the fair value option reported in net realized capital gains and losses in the Company’s Condensed Consolidated Statements of Operations.
 
Three Months Ended March 31,
 
2015
2014
Assets
 
 
Fixed maturities, FVO
 
 
Corporate
$

$
2

CRE CDOs
1

8

Foreign government

1

RMBS
1

1

Total fixed maturities, FVO
$
2

$
12

Equity, FVO
2


Total realized capital gains (losses)
$
4

$
12

The following table presents the fair value of assets and liabilities accounted for using the fair value option included in the Company’s Condensed Consolidated Balance Sheets.
 
As of
 
March 31, 2015
December 31, 2014
Assets
 
 
Fixed maturities, FVO
 
 
ABS
$
15

$
15

CRE CDOs
72

69

CMBS
21

22

Corporate
135

133

Foreign government
29

30

U.S government
5

2

Municipals
1

2

RMBS
242

215

Total fixed maturities, FVO
$
520

$
488

Equity, FVO [1]
$
402

$
348

[1]
Included in equity securities, AFS on the Condensed Consolidated Balance Sheets.

30

Table of Contents
THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)
4. Fair Value Measurements (continued)

Financial Instruments Not Carried at Fair Value
The following table presents carrying amounts and fair values of the Company’s financial instruments not carried at fair value and not included in the preceding fair value discussion.
 
 
March 31, 2015
December 31, 2014
 
Fair Value Hierarchy Level
Carrying Amount
Fair Value
Carrying Amount
Fair Value
Assets
 
 
 
 
 
Policy loans
Level 3
$
1,452

$
1,452

$
1,431

$
1,431

Mortgage loans
Level 3
5,697

5,963

5,556

5,840

Liabilities
 
 
 
 
 
Other policyholder funds and benefits payable [1]
Level 3
$
7,009

$
7,238

$
7,304

$
7,522

Senior notes [2]
Level 2
4,721

5,606

5,009

5,837

Junior subordinated debentures [2]
Level 2
1,100

1,308

1,100

1,291

Consumer notes [3] [4]
Level 3
66

66

68

68

Assumed investment contracts [4]
Level 3
770

848

763

851

[1]
Excludes guarantees on variable annuities, group accident and health and universal life insurance contracts, including corporate owned life insurance.
[2]
Included in long-term debt in the Condensed Consolidated Balance Sheets, except for current maturities, which are included in short-term debt.
[3]
Excludes amounts carried at fair value and included in preceding disclosures.
[4]
Included in other liabilities in the Condensed Consolidated Balance Sheets.
Fair values for policy loans were determined using current loan coupon rates, which reflect the current rates available under the contracts. As a result, the fair value approximates the carrying value of the policy loans.
Fair values for mortgage loans were estimated using discounted cash flow calculations based on current lending rates for similar type loans. Current lending rates reflect changes in credit spreads and the remaining terms of the loans.
Fair values for other policyholder funds and benefits payable and assumed investment contracts, not carried at fair value, are estimated based on the cash surrender values of the underlying policies or by estimating future cash flows discounted at current interest rates adjusted for credit risk.
Fair values for senior notes and junior subordinated debentures are determined using the market approach based on reported trades, benchmark interest rates and issuer spread for the Company which may consider credit default swaps.
Fair values for consumer notes were estimated using discounted cash flow calculations using current interest rates adjusted for estimated loan durations.

31

Table of Contents
THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)
5. Investments and Derivative Instruments

Net Realized Capital Gains (Losses)
 
Three Months Ended March 31,
(Before tax)
2015
2014
Gross gains on sales
$
197

$
183

Gross losses on sales
(148
)
(129
)
Net OTTI losses recognized in earnings
(12
)
(22
)
Valuation allowances on mortgage loans
(3
)

Periodic net coupon settlements on credit derivatives
1

(1
)
Results of variable annuity hedge program


GMWB derivatives, net
1

15

Macro hedge program
(4
)
(10
)
Total results of variable annuity hedge program
(3
)
5

Other, net [1]
(27
)
(71
)
Net realized capital gains
$
5

$
(35
)
[1]
Primarily consists of changes in the value of non-qualifying derivatives, transactional foreign currency revaluation gains (losses) on the Japan fixed payout annuity liabilities assumed from HLIKK and gains (losses) on non-qualifying derivatives used to hedge the foreign currency exposure of the liabilities. For the three months ended March 31, 2015 and 2014, gains (losses) from transactional foreign currency revaluation of the Japan fixed payout annuity liabilities were $0 and $(28), respectively. For the three months ended March 31, 2015 and 2014, gains (losses) on instruments used to hedge the foreign currency exposure on the fixed payout annuities were $(14) and $15, respectively.
Net realized capital gains and losses from investment sales are reported as a component of revenues and are determined on a specific identification basis. Before tax, net gains and losses on sales and impairments previously reported as unrealized gains in AOCI were $37 and $44 for the three months ended March 31, 2015 and 2014, respectively. Proceeds from sales of AFS securities totaled $6.2 billion and $8.6 billion for the three months ended March 31, 2015, and 2014, respectively.
Recognition and Presentation of Other-Than-Temporary Impairments
The Company deems bonds and certain equity securities with debt-like characteristics (collectively “debt securities”) to be other-than-temporarily impaired (“impaired”) if a security meets the following conditions: a) the Company intends to sell or it is more likely than not that the Company will be required to sell the security before a recovery in value, or b) the Company does not expect to recover the entire amortized cost basis of the security. If the Company intends to sell or it is more likely than not that the Company will be required to sell the security before a recovery in value, a charge is recorded in net realized capital losses equal to the difference between the fair value and amortized cost basis of the security. For those impaired debt securities which do not meet the first condition and for which the Company does not expect to recover the entire amortized cost basis, the difference between the security’s amortized cost basis and the fair value is separated into the portion representing a credit OTTI, which is recorded in net realized capital losses, and the remaining non-credit impairment, which is recorded in OCI. Generally, the Company determines a security’s credit impairment as the difference between its amortized cost basis and its best estimate of expected future cash flows discounted at the security’s effective yield prior to impairment. The remaining non-credit impairment is the difference between the security’s fair value and the Company’s best estimate of expected future cash flows discounted at the security’s effective yield prior to the impairment, which typically represents current market liquidity and risk premiums. The previous amortized cost basis less the impairment recognized in net realized capital losses becomes the security’s new cost basis. The Company accretes the new cost basis to the estimated future cash flows over the expected remaining life of the security by prospectively adjusting the security’s yield, if necessary.

32

Table of Contents
THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)
5. Investments and Derivative Instruments (continued)

The Company’s evaluation of whether a credit impairment exists for debt securities includes but is not limited to, the following factors: (a) changes in the financial condition of the security’s underlying collateral, (b) whether the issuer is current on contractually obligated interest and principal payments, (c) changes in the financial condition, credit rating and near-term prospects of the issuer, (d) the extent to which the fair value has been less than the amortized cost of the security and (e) the payment structure of the security. The Company’s best estimate of expected future cash flows used to determine the credit loss amount is a quantitative and qualitative process that incorporates information received from third-party sources along with certain internal assumptions and judgments regarding the future performance of the security. The Company’s best estimate of future cash flows involves assumptions including, but not limited to, various performance indicators, such as historical and projected default and recovery rates, credit ratings, current and projected delinquency rates, and loan-to-value ("LTV") ratios. In addition, for structured securities, the Company considers factors including, but not limited to, average cumulative collateral loss rates that vary by vintage year, commercial and residential property value declines that vary by property type and location and commercial real estate delinquency levels. These assumptions require the use of significant management judgment and include the probability of issuer default and estimates regarding timing and amount of expected recoveries which may include estimating the underlying collateral value. In addition, projections of expected future debt security cash flows may change based upon new information regarding the performance of the issuer and/or underlying collateral such as changes in the projections of the underlying property value estimates.
For equity securities where the decline in the fair value is deemed to be other-than-temporary, a charge is recorded in net realized capital losses equal to the difference between the fair value and cost basis of the security. The previous cost basis less the impairment becomes the security’s new cost basis. The Company asserts its intent and ability to retain those equity securities deemed to be temporarily impaired until the price recovers. Once identified, these securities are systematically restricted from trading unless approved by investment and accounting professionals. The investment and accounting professionals will only authorize the sale of these securities based on predefined criteria that relate to events that could not have been reasonably foreseen. Examples of the criteria include, but are not limited to, the deterioration in the issuer’s financial condition, security price declines, a change in regulatory requirements or a major business combination or major disposition.
The primary factors considered in evaluating whether an impairment exists for an equity security include, but are not limited to: (a) the length of time and extent to which the fair value has been less than the cost of the security, (b) changes in the financial condition, credit rating and near-term prospects of the issuer, (c) whether the issuer is current on preferred stock dividends and (d) the intent and ability of the Company to retain the investment for a period of time sufficient to allow for recovery.
Impairments for the three months ended March 31, 2015 and 2014 were $12 and $22, respectively. Impairments for the three months ended March 31, 2015 primarily consisted of securities in an unrealized loss which the Company had the intent-to-sell. Impairments for the three months ended March 31, 2014 primarily consisted of credit impairments caused by issuer specific deterioration.
The following table presents a roll-forward of the Company’s cumulative credit impairments on debt securities held.
 
Three Months Ended March 31,
(Before-tax)
2015
2014
Balance as of beginning of period
$
(424
)
$
(552
)
Additions for credit impairments recognized on [1]:


Securities not previously impaired
(3
)
(7
)
Securities previously impaired

(11
)
Reductions for credit impairments previously recognized on:


Securities that matured or were sold during the period
4

33

Securities the Company made the decision to sell or more likely than not will be required to sell
2


Securities due to an increase in expected cash flows
9

6

Balance as of end of period
$
(412
)
$
(531
)
[1]
These additions are included in the net OTTI losses recognized in earnings in the Condensed Consolidated Statements of Operations.

33

Table of Contents
THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)
5. Investments and Derivative Instruments (continued)

Available-for-Sale Securities
The following table presents the Company’s AFS securities by type.
 
March 31, 2015
 
December 31, 2014
 
Cost or
Amortized
Cost
Gross
Unrealized
Gains
Gross
Unrealized
Losses
Fair
Value
Non-Credit
OTTI [1]
 
Cost or
Amortized
Cost
Gross
Unrealized
Gains
Gross
Unrealized
Losses
Fair
Value
Non-Credit
OTTI [1]
ABS
$
2,997

$
41

$
(34
)
$
3,004

$

 
$
2,470

$
39

$
(37
)
$
2,472

$
(1
)
CDOs [2]
2,891

115

(22
)
2,982


 
2,776

98

(36
)
2,841


CMBS
4,445

223

(16
)
4,652

(7
)
 
4,235

196

(16
)
4,415

(6
)
Corporate
24,698

2,558

(137
)
27,119

(6
)
 
25,188

2,382

(211
)
27,359

(3
)
Foreign govt./govt. agencies
1,310

69

(14
)
1,365


 
1,592

73

(29
)
1,636


Municipal
11,656

1,189

(3
)
12,842


 
11,735

1,141

(5
)
12,871


RMBS
3,963

132

(17
)
4,078

(1
)
 
3,815

122

(19
)
3,918

(1
)
U.S. Treasuries
4,144

371

(2
)
4,513


 
3,551

326

(5
)
3,872


Total fixed maturities, AFS
56,104

4,698

(245
)
60,555

(14
)
 
55,362

4,377

(358
)
59,384

(11
)
Equity securities, AFS [3]
726

48

(28
)
746


 
676

50

(27
)
699


Total AFS securities
$
56,830

$
4,746

$
(273
)
$
61,301

$
(14
)
 
$
56,038

$
4,427

$
(385
)
$
60,083

$
(11
)
[1]
Represents the amount of cumulative non-credit OTTI losses recognized in OCI on securities that also had credit impairments. These losses are included in gross unrealized losses as of March 31, 2015 and December 31, 2014.
[2]
Gross unrealized gains (losses) exclude the fair value of bifurcated, embedded derivative features of certain securities. Subsequent changes in value are recorded in net realized capital gains (losses).
[3]
Excludes equity securities, FVO, with a cost and fair value of $403 and $402, respectively, as of March 31, 2015, and $351 and $348, respectively, as of December 31, 2014.
The following table presents the Company’s fixed maturities, AFS, by contractual maturity year.
 
March 31, 2015
December 31, 2014
Contractual Maturity
Amortized Cost
Fair Value
Amortized Cost
Fair Value
One year or less
$
1,832

$
1,856

$
2,141

$
2,168

Over one year through five years
11,883

12,446

11,264

11,827

Over five years through ten years
8,778

9,294

8,802

9,226

Over ten years
19,315

22,243

19,859

22,517

Subtotal
41,808

45,839

42,066

45,738

Mortgage-backed and asset-backed securities
14,296

14,716

13,296

13,646

Total fixed maturities, AFS
$
56,104

$
60,555

$
55,362

$
59,384

Estimated maturities may differ from contractual maturities due to security call or prepayment provisions. Due to the potential for variability in payment speeds (i.e. prepayments or extensions), mortgage-backed and asset-backed securities are not categorized by contractual maturity.
Concentration of Credit Risk
The Company aims to maintain a diversified investment portfolio including issuer, sector and geographic stratification, where applicable, and has established certain exposure limits, diversification standards and review procedures to mitigate credit risk. The Company did not have exposure to any credit concentration risk of a single issuer greater than 10% of the Company's stockholders' equity, other than the U.S. government and certain U.S. government securities as of March 31, 2015 or December 31, 2014.

34

Table of Contents
THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)
5. Investments and Derivative Instruments (continued)

Unrealized Losses on AFS Securities
The following tables present the Company’s unrealized loss aging for AFS securities by type and length of time the security was in a continuous unrealized loss position.
 
March 31, 2015
 
Less Than 12 Months
 
12 Months or More
 
Total
 
Amortized Cost
Fair Value
Unrealized Losses
 
Amortized Cost
Fair Value
Unrealized Losses
 
Amortized Cost
Fair Value
Unrealized Losses
ABS
$
736

$
735

$
(1
)
 
$
416

$
383

$
(33
)
 
$
1,152

$
1,118

$
(34
)
CDOs [1]
593

591

(2
)
 
1,341

1,319

(20
)
 
1,934

1,910

(22
)
CMBS
233

230

(3
)
 
192

179

(13
)
 
425

409

(16
)
Corporate
2,086

2,022

(64
)
 
710

637

(73
)
 
2,796

2,659

(137
)
Foreign govt./govt. agencies
251

244

(7
)
 
118

111

(7
)
 
369

355

(14
)
Municipal
169

167

(2
)
 
33

32

(1
)
 
202

199

(3
)
RMBS
717

714

(3
)
 
277

263

(14
)
 
994

977

(17
)
U.S. Treasuries
245

244

(1
)
 
62

61

(1
)
 
307

305

(2
)
Total fixed maturities, AFS
5,030

4,947

(83
)
 
3,149

2,985

(162
)
 
8,179

7,932

(245
)
Equity securities, AFS [2]
198

185

(13
)
 
108

93

(15
)
 
306

278

(28
)
Total securities in an unrealized loss position
$
5,228

$
5,132

$
(96
)
 
$
3,257

$
3,078

$
(177
)
 
$
8,485

$
8,210

$
(273
)
 
December 31, 2014
 
Less Than 12 Months
 
12 Months or More
 
Total
 
Amortized Cost
Fair Value
Unrealized Losses
 
Amortized Cost
Fair Value
Unrealized Losses
 
Amortized Cost
Fair Value
Unrealized Losses
ABS
$
897

$
893

$
(4
)
 
$
473

$
440

$
(33
)
 
$
1,370

$
1,333

$
(37
)
CDOs [1]
748

743

(5
)
 
1,489

1,461

(31
)
 
2,237

2,204

(36
)
CMBS
230

227

(3
)
 
319

306

(13
)
 
549

533

(16
)
Corporate
3,082

2,980

(102
)
 
1,177

1,068

(109
)
 
4,259

4,048

(211
)
Foreign govt./govt. agencies
363

349

(14
)
 
227

212

(15
)
 
590

561

(29
)
Municipal
74

73

(1
)
 
86

82

(4
)
 
160

155

(5
)
RMBS
320

318

(2
)
 
433

416

(17
)
 
753

734

(19
)
U.S. Treasuries
432

431

(1
)
 
361

357

(4
)
 
793

788

(5
)
Total fixed maturities, AFS
6,146

6,014

(132
)
 
4,565

4,342

(226
)
 
10,711

10,356

(358
)
Equity securities, AFS [2]
172

160

(12
)
 
102

87

(15
)
 
274

247

(27
)
Total securities in an unrealized loss position
$
6,318

$
6,174

$
(144
)
 
$
4,667

$
4,429

$
(241
)
 
$
10,985

$
10,603

$
(385
)
[1]
Unrealized losses exclude the change in fair value of bifurcated embedded derivative features of certain securities, for which changes in fair value are recorded in net realized capital gains (losses).
[2]
As of March 31, 2015 and December 31, 2014, excludes equity securities, FVO which are included in equity securities, AFS on the Condensed Consolidated Balance Sheets.
As of March 31, 2015, AFS securities in an unrealized loss position, consisted of 2,740 securities, primarily in the corporate sector, which are depressed primarily due to an increase in interest rates and/or wider credit spreads since the securities were purchased. As of March 31, 2015, 91% of these securities were depressed less than 20% of cost or amortized cost. The decrease in unrealized losses as compared to December 31, 2014, was primarily attributable to a decrease in interest rates.

35

Table of Contents
THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)
5. Investments and Derivative Instruments (continued)

Most of the securities depressed for twelve months or more relate to certain floating rate corporate securities with greater than 10 years to maturity concentrated in the financial services sector, structured securities with exposure to commercial and residential real estate and student loan ABS. Corporate securities and student loan ABS, are primarily depressed because the securities have floating-rate coupons and have long-dated maturities, or are perpetual, and current credit spreads are wider than when these securities were purchased. For certain commercial and residential real estate securities, current market spreads continue to be wider than spreads at the securities' respective purchase dates. The Company neither has an intention to sell nor does it expect to be required to sell the securities outlined in the preceding discussion.
Mortgage Loans
Mortgage Loan Valuation Allowances
The Company’s security monitoring process reviews mortgage loans on a quarterly basis to identify potential credit losses. Commercial mortgage loans are considered to be impaired when management estimates that, based upon current information and events, it is probable that the Company will be unable to collect amounts due according to the contractual terms of the loan agreement. Criteria used to determine if an impairment exists include, but are not limited to: current and projected macroeconomic factors, such as unemployment rates, and property-specific factors such as rental rates, occupancy levels, LTV ratios and debt service coverage ratios (“DSCR”). In addition, the Company considers historic, current and projected delinquency rates and property values. These assumptions require the use of significant management judgment and include the probability and timing of borrower default and loss severity estimates. In addition, projections of expected future cash flows may change based upon new information regarding the performance of the borrower and/or underlying collateral such as changes in the projections of the underlying property value estimates.
For mortgage loans that are deemed impaired, a valuation allowance is established for the difference between the carrying amount and the Company’s share of either (a) the present value of the expected future cash flows discounted at the loan’s effective interest rate, (b) the loan’s observable market price or, most frequently, (c) the fair value of the collateral. A valuation allowance has been established for either individual loans or as a projected loss contingency for loans with an LTV ratio of 90% or greater and consideration of other credit quality factors, including DSCR. Changes in valuation allowances are recorded in net realized capital gains and losses. Interest income on impaired loans is accrued to the extent it is deemed collectible and the loans continue to perform under the original or restructured terms. Interest income ceases to accrue for loans when it is probable that the Company will not receive interest and principal payments according to the contractual terms of the loan agreement. Loans may resume accrual status when it is determined that sufficient collateral exists to satisfy the full amount of the loan and interest payments, as well as when it is probable cash will be received in the foreseeable future. Interest income on defaulted loans is recognized when received.
 
March 31, 2015
 
December 31, 2014
 
Amortized Cost [1]
Valuation Allowance
Carrying Value
 
Amortized Cost [1]
Valuation Allowance
Carrying Value
Total commercial mortgage loans
$
5,718

$
(21
)
$
5,697

 
$
5,574

$
(18
)
$
5,556

[1]
Amortized cost represents carrying value prior to valuation allowances, if any.
As of March 31, 2015 and December 31, 2014, the carrying value of mortgage loans associated with the valuation allowance was $110 and $140, respectively. There were no mortgage loans held-for-sale as of March 31, 2015 or December 31, 2014. As of March 31, 2015, loans within the Company’s mortgage loan portfolio that have had extensions or restructurings other than what is allowable under the original terms of the contract are immaterial.
The following table presents the activity within the Company’s valuation allowance for mortgage loans. These loans have been evaluated both individually and collectively for impairment. Loans evaluated collectively for impairment are immaterial.
 
2015
2014
Balance, as of January 1
$
(18
)
$
(67
)
(Additions)/Reversals
(3
)

Deductions

50

Balance, as of March 31
$
(21
)
$
(17
)

36

Table of Contents
THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)
5. Investments and Derivative Instruments (continued)

The weighted-average LTV ratio of the Company’s commercial mortgage loan portfolio was 57% as of March 31, 2015, while the weighted-average LTV ratio at origination of these loans was 62%. LTV ratios compare the loan amount to the value of the underlying property collateralizing the loan. The loan values are updated no less than annually through property level reviews of the portfolio. Factors considered in the property valuation include, but are not limited to, actual and expected property cash flows, geographic market data and capitalization rates. DSCR compares a property’s net operating income to the borrower’s principal and interest payments. The weighted average DSCR of the Company’s commercial mortgage loan portfolio was 2.51x as of March 31, 2015. As of March 31, 2015 and December 31, 2014, the Company held one delinquent commercial mortgage loan past due by 90 days or more. The loan had a total carrying value and valuation allowance of $7 and $0, respectively, and was not accruing income.
The following table presents the carrying value of the Company’s commercial mortgage loans by LTV and DSCR.
Commercial Mortgage Loans Credit Quality
 
March 31, 2015
 
December 31, 2014
Loan-to-value
Carrying Value
Avg. Debt-Service Coverage Ratio
 
Carrying Value
Avg. Debt-Service Coverage Ratio
Greater than 80%
$
49

1.12x
 
$
53

1.07x
65% - 80%
928

1.73x
 
789

1.75x
Less than 65%
4,720

2.69x
 
4,714

2.66x
Total commercial mortgage loans
$
5,697

2.51x
 
$
5,556

2.51x
 
The following tables present the carrying value of the Company’s mortgage loans by region and property type.
Mortgage Loans by Region
 
March 31, 2015
 
December 31, 2014
 
Carrying Value
Percent of Total
 
Carrying Value
Percent of Total
East North Central
$
231

4.1
%
 
$
211

3.8
%
Middle Atlantic
452

7.9
%
 
468

8.4
%
Mountain
88

1.5
%
 
88

1.6
%
New England
381

6.7
%
 
381

6.9
%
Pacific
1,646

28.9
%
 
1,607

29.0
%
South Atlantic
1,104

19.4
%
 
1,019

18.3
%
West North Central
44

0.8
%
 
44

0.8
%
West South Central
319

5.6
%
 
302

5.4
%
Other [1]
1,432

25.1
%
 
1,436

25.8
%
Total mortgage loans
$
5,697

100.0
%
 
$
5,556

100.0
%
[1]
Primarily represents loans collateralized by multiple properties in various regions.
Mortgage Loans by Property Type
 
March 31, 2015
 
December 31, 2014
 
Carrying Value
Percent of Total
 
Carrying
Value
Percent of Total
Commercial
 
 
 
 
 
Agricultural
$
46

0.8
%
 
$
46

0.8
%
Industrial
1,465

25.7
%
 
1,476

26.6
%
Lodging
26

0.5
%
 
26

0.5
%
Multifamily
1,267

22.2
%
 
1,190

21.4
%
Office
1,538

27.0
%
 
1,517

27.3
%
Retail
1,204

21.1
%
 
1,147

20.6
%
Other
151

2.7
%
 
154

2.8
%
Total mortgage loans
$
5,697

100.0
%
 
$
5,556

100.0
%

37

Table of Contents
THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)
5. Investments and Derivative Instruments (continued)

Variable Interest Entities
The Company is involved with various special purpose entities and other entities that are deemed to be VIEs primarily as a collateral or investment manager and as an investor through normal investment activities, as well as a means of accessing capital through a contingent capital facility.
A VIE is an entity that either has investors that lack certain essential characteristics of a controlling financial interest or lacks sufficient funds to finance its own activities without financial support provided by other entities. The Company performs ongoing qualitative assessments of its VIEs to determine whether the Company has a controlling financial interest in the VIE and therefore is the primary beneficiary. The Company is deemed to have a controlling financial interest when it has both the ability to direct the activities that most significantly impact the economic performance of the VIE and the obligation to absorb losses or right to receive benefits from the VIE that could potentially be significant to the VIE. Based on the Company’s assessment, if it determines it is the primary beneficiary, the Company consolidates the VIE in the Company’s Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements.
Consolidated VIEs
The following table presents the carrying value of assets and liabilities, and the maximum exposure to loss relating to the VIEs for which the Company is the primary beneficiary. Creditors have no recourse against the Company in the event of default by these VIEs nor does the Company have any implied or unfunded commitments to these VIEs. The Company’s financial or other support provided to these VIEs is limited to its collateral or investment management services and original investment.
 
March 31, 2015
 
December 31, 2014
 
Total Assets
Total Liabilities [1]
Maximum Exposure to Loss [2]
 
Total Assets
Total Liabilities [1]
Maximum Exposure to Loss [2]
CDOs [3]
$
5

$
5

$

 
$
5

$
5

$

Investment funds [4]
232


235

 
238


243

Limited partnerships and other alternative investments
2


2

 
3

1

2

Total
$
239

$
5

$
237

 
$
246

$
6

$
245

[1]
Included in other liabilities in the Company’s Condensed Consolidated Balance Sheets.
[2]
The maximum exposure to loss represents the maximum loss amount that the Company could recognize as a reduction in net investment income or as a realized capital loss and is the cost basis of the Company’s investment.
[3]
Total assets included in cash in the Company’s Condensed Consolidated Balance Sheets.
[4]
Total assets included in fixed maturities, FVO, short-term investments, equity, AFS, and cash in the Company’s Condensed Consolidated Balance Sheets.
CDOs represent structured investment vehicles for which the Company has a controlling financial interest as it provides collateral management services, earns a fee for those services and also holds investments in the securities issued by these vehicles. Investment funds represent wholly-owned fixed income funds for which the Company has management and control of the investments which is the activity that most significantly impacts its economic performance. Limited partnerships represent one hedge fund of funds for which the Company holds a majority interest in the fund as an investment.
Non-Consolidated VIEs
The Company holds a significant variable interest for one VIE for which it is not the primary beneficiary and, therefore, was not consolidated on the Company’s Condensed Consolidated Balance Sheets. This VIE represents a contingent capital facility ("facility") that has been held by the Company since February 2007 and for which the Company has no implied or unfunded commitments. Assets and liabilities recorded for the contingent capital facility were $11 and $11, respectively, as of March 31, 2015 and $12 and $14, respectively, as of December 31, 2014. Additionally, the Company has a maximum exposure to loss of $3 and $3, respectively, as of March 31, 2015 and December 31, 2014, which represents the issuance costs that were incurred to establish the facility. The Company does not have a controlling financial interest as it does not manage the assets of the facility nor does it have the obligation to absorb losses or the right to receive benefits that could potentially be significant to the facility, as the asset manager has significant variable interest in the vehicle. The Company’s financial or other support provided to the facility is limited to providing ongoing support to cover the facility’s operating expenses. For further information on the facility, see Note 12 - Debt of Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements included in The Hartford’s 2014 Form 10-K Annual Report.

38

Table of Contents
THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)
5. Investments and Derivative Instruments (continued)

In addition, the Company, through normal investment activities, makes passive investments in structured securities issued by VIEs for which the Company is not the manager which are included in ABS, CDOs, CMBS and RMBS in the Available-for-Sale Securities table and fixed maturities, FVO, in the Company’s Condensed Consolidated Balance Sheets. The Company has not provided financial or other support with respect to these investments other than its original investment. For these investments, the Company determined it is not the primary beneficiary due to the relative size of the Company’s investment in comparison to the principal amount of the structured securities issued by the VIEs, the level of credit subordination which reduces the Company’s obligation to absorb losses or right to receive benefits and the Company’s inability to direct the activities that most significantly impact the economic performance of the VIEs. The Company’s maximum exposure to loss on these investments is limited to the amount of the Company’s investment.
Repurchase Agreements, Dollar Roll Transactions and Other Collateral Transactions
From time to time, the Company enters into repurchase agreements and dollar roll transactions to manage liquidity or to earn incremental spread income. A repurchase agreement is a transaction in which one party (transferor) agrees to sell securities to another party (transferee) in return for cash (or securities), with a simultaneous agreement to repurchase the same securities at a specified price at a later date. A dollar roll is a type of repurchase agreement where a mortgage backed security is sold with an agreement to repurchase substantially the same security at a specified time in the future. These transactions generally have a contractual maturity of ninety days or less and the carrying amounts of these instruments approximates fair value.
As part of repurchase agreements and dollar roll transactions, the Company transfers collateral of U.S. government and government agency securities and receives cash. For the repurchase agreements, the Company obtains cash in an amount equal to at least 95% of the fair value of the securities transferred. The agreements contain contractual provisions that require additional collateral to be transferred when necessary and provide the counterparty the right to sell or re-pledge the securities transferred. The cash received from the repurchase program is typically invested in short-term investments or fixed maturities. Repurchase agreements include master netting provisions that provide the counterparties the right to offset claims and apply securities held by them with respect to their obligations in the event of a default. Although the Company has the contractual right to offset claims, fixed maturities do not meet the specific conditions for net presentation under U.S. GAAP. The Company accounts for the repurchase agreements and dollar roll transactions as collateralized borrowings. The securities transferred under repurchase agreements and dollar roll transactions are included in fixed maturities, AFS with the obligation to repurchase those securities recorded in other liabilities on the Company's Condensed Consolidated Balance Sheets.
As of March 31, 2015, the Company reported in fixed maturities, AFS on the Condensed Consolidated Balance Sheets financial collateral pledged relating to repurchase agreements of $323. The Company reported a corresponding obligation to repurchase the pledged securities of $323 in other liabilities on the Condensed Consolidated Balance Sheets. The Company had no outstanding dollar roll transactions as of March 31, 2015. The Company had no outstanding repurchase agreements or dollar roll transactions as of December 31, 2014.
The Company is required by law to deposit securities with government agencies in certain states in which it conducts business. As of March 31, 2015 and December 31, 2014, the fair value of securities on deposit was approximately $2.7 billion and $2.5 billion, respectively.
As of March 31, 2015 and December 31, 2014, the Company has pledged as collateral $34 and $34, respectively, of U.S. government securities and government agency securities or cash for letters of credit.
Refer to Derivative Collateral Arrangements section of this note for disclosure of collateral in support of derivative transactions.
Derivative Instruments
The Company utilizes a variety of OTC, OTC-cleared and exchange traded derivative instruments as a part of its overall risk management strategy as well as to enter into replication transactions. Derivative instruments are used to manage risk associated with interest rate, equity market, commodity market, credit spread, issuer default, price, and currency exchange rate risk or volatility. Replication transactions are used as an economical means to synthetically replicate the characteristics and performance of assets that would be permissible investments under the Company’s investment policies. The Company also may enter into and has previously issued financial instruments and products that either are accounted for as free-standing derivatives, such as certain reinsurance contracts, or may contain features that are deemed to be embedded derivative instruments, such as the GMWB rider included with certain variable annuity products.

39

Table of Contents
THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)
5. Investments and Derivative Instruments (continued)

Strategies that qualify for hedge accounting
Certain derivatives that the Company enters into satisfy the hedge accounting requirements as outlined in Note 1 - Basis of Presentation and Significant Accounting Policies of Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements, included in The Hartford’s 2014 Form 10-K Annual Report. Typically, these hedge relationships include interest rate and foreign currency swaps where the terms or expected cash flows of the hedged item closely match the terms of the swap. The swaps are typically used to manage interest rate duration of certain fixed maturity securities or liability contracts. The hedge strategies by hedge accounting designation include:
Cash flow hedges
Interest rate swaps are predominantly used to manage portfolio duration and better match cash receipts from assets with cash disbursements required to fund liabilities. These derivatives primarily convert interest receipts on floating-rate fixed maturity securities to fixed rates. The Company also enters into forward starting swap agreements to hedge the interest rate exposure related to the purchase of fixed-rate securities, primarily to hedge interest rate risk inherent in the assumptions used to price certain liabilities.
Foreign currency swaps are used to convert foreign currency-denominated cash flows related to certain investment receipts and liability payments to U.S. dollars in order to reduce cash flow fluctuations due to changes in currency rates.
Fair value hedges
Interest rate swaps are used to hedge the changes in fair value of fixed maturity securities due to fluctuations in interest rates.
Non-qualifying strategies
Derivative relationships that do not qualify for hedge accounting (“non-qualifying strategies”) primarily include the hedge program for the Company's variable annuity products as well as the hedging and replication strategies that utilize credit default swaps. In addition, hedges of interest rate, foreign currency, and commodity risk of certain fixed maturities and liabilities do not qualify for hedge accounting.
The non-qualifying strategies include:
Interest rate swaps, swaptions and futures
The Company uses interest rate swaps, swaptions and futures to manage duration between assets and liabilities in certain investment portfolios. In addition, the Company enters into interest rate swaps to terminate existing swaps, thereby offsetting the changes in value of the original swap. As of March 31, 2015 and December 31, 2014 the notional amount of interest rate swaps in offsetting relationships was $13.1 billion.
Foreign currency swaps and forwards
The Company enters into foreign currency swaps and forwards to convert the foreign currency exposures of certain foreign currency-denominated fixed maturity investments to U.S. dollars.
Japan fixed payout annuity hedge
The Company formerly offered certain variable annuity products with a guaranteed minimum income benefit ("GMIB") through HLIKK, a former indirect wholly-owned subsidiary that was sold in 2014. The Company will continue to reinsure from HLIKK certain Japan fixed payout annuities. The Company invests in U.S. dollar denominated assets to support the reinsurance liability. The Company entered into pay U.S. dollar, receive yen swap contracts to hedge the currency and yen interest rate exposure between the U.S. dollar denominated assets and the yen denominated fixed liability reinsurance payments.
Credit contracts
Credit default swaps are used to purchase credit protection on an individual entity or referenced index to economically hedge against default risk and credit-related changes in value on fixed maturity securities. Credit default swaps are also used to assume credit risk related to an individual entity or referenced index as a part of replication transactions. These contracts require the Company to pay or receive a periodic fee in exchange for compensation from the counterparty should the referenced security issuers experience a credit event, as defined in the contract. The Company is also exposed to credit risk related to certain structured fixed maturity securities that have embedded credit derivatives, which reference a standard index of corporate securities. In addition, the Company enters into credit default swaps to terminate existing credit default swaps, thereby offsetting the changes in value of the original swap going forward.

40

Table of Contents
THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)
5. Investments and Derivative Instruments (continued)

Equity index swaps and options
The Company enters into total return swaps to hedge equity risk of specific common stock investments which are accounted for using fair value option in order to align the accounting treatment within net realized capital gains (losses). The Company also enters into equity index options with the purpose of hedging the impact of an adverse equity market environment on the investment portfolio. In addition, the Company formerly offered certain equity indexed products, a portion of which contain embedded derivatives that require bifurcation. The Company uses equity index swaps to economically hedge the equity volatility risk associated with the equity indexed products.
Commodity contracts
During 2015 the Company purchased for $11 put option contracts on West Texas Intermediate oil futures with a strike of $35 dollars per barrel in order to partially offset potential losses related to certain fixed maturity securities that could arise if oil prices decline substantially.
GMWB derivatives, net
The Company formerly offered certain variable annuity products with GMWB riders. The GMWB product is a bifurcated embedded derivative (“GMWB product derivatives”) that has a notional value equal to the GRB. The Company uses reinsurance contracts to transfer a portion of its risk of loss due to GMWB. The reinsurance contracts covering GMWB (“GMWB reinsurance contracts”) are accounted for as free-standing derivatives with a notional amount equal to the GRB amount.
The Company utilizes derivatives (“GMWB hedging instruments”) as part of an actively managed program designed to hedge a portion of the capital market risk exposures of the non-reinsured GMWB riders due to changes in interest rates, equity market levels, and equity volatility. These derivatives include customized swaps, interest rate swaps and futures, and equity swaps, options and futures, on certain indices including the S&P 500 index, EAFE index and NASDAQ index. The following table presents notional and fair value for GMWB hedging instruments.
 
Notional Amount
 
Fair Value
 
March 31,
2015
December 31, 2014
 
March 31,
2015
December 31, 2014
Customized swaps
$
6,806

$
7,041

 
$
144

$
124

Equity swaps, options, and futures
1,803

3,761

 
11

39

Interest rate swaps and futures
3,570

3,640

 
26

11

Total
$
12,179

$
14,442

 
$
181

$
174

Macro hedge program
The Company utilizes equity options, swaps, futures, and foreign currency options to partially hedge against a decline in the equity markets and the resulting statutory surplus and capital impact primarily arising from the guaranteed minimum death benefit ("GMDB") and GMWB obligations. The following table presents notional and fair value for the macro hedge program.
 
Notional Amount
 
Fair Value
 
March 31,
2015
December 31, 2014
 
March 31,
2015
December 31, 2014
Equity swaps, options, and futures
7,342

5,983

 
187

141

Foreign currency options
400

400

 


Total
$
7,742

$
6,383

 
$
187

$
141

Contingent capital facility put option
The Company entered into a put option agreement that provides the Company the right to require a third-party trust to purchase, at any time, The Hartford’s junior subordinated notes in a maximum aggregate principal amount of $500. Under the put option agreement, The Hartford will pay premiums on a periodic basis and will reimburse the trust for certain fees and ordinary expenses.

41

Table of Contents
THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)
5. Investments and Derivative Instruments (continued)

Modified coinsurance reinsurance contracts
As of March 31, 2015 and December 31, 2014, the Company had approximately $1.0 billion of invested assets supporting other policyholder funds and benefits payable reinsured under a modified coinsurance arrangement in connection with the sale of the Individual Life business which was structured as a reinsurance transaction. The assets are primarily held in a trust established by the Company. The Company pays or receives cash quarterly to settle the results of the reinsured business, including the investment results. As a result of this modified coinsurance arrangement, the Company has an embedded derivative that transfers to the reinsurer certain unrealized changes in fair value due to interest rate and credit risks of these assets. The notional amounts of the embedded derivative reinsurance contracts are the invested assets that are carried at fair value supporting the reinsured reserves.
Derivative Balance Sheet Classification
The following table summarizes the balance sheet classification of the Company’s derivative related fair value amounts as well as the gross asset and liability fair value amounts. For reporting purposes, the Company has elected to offset the fair value amounts, income accruals, and related cash collateral receivables and payables of OTC derivative instruments executed in a legal entity and with the same counterparty under a master netting agreement, which provides the Company with the legal right of offset. The Company has also elected to offset the fair value amounts, income accruals and related cash collateral receivables and payables of OTC-cleared derivative instruments based on clearing house agreements. The following fair value amounts do not include income accruals or related cash collateral receivables and payables, which are netted with derivative fair value amounts to determine balance sheet presentation. Derivative fair value reported as liabilities after taking into account the master netting agreements is $1.1 billion as of March 31, 2015, and December 31, 2014. Derivatives in the Company’s separate accounts, where the associated gains and losses accrue directly to policyholders, are not included. The Company’s derivative instruments are held for risk management purposes, unless otherwise noted in the following table. The notional amount of derivative contracts represents the basis upon which pay or receive amounts are calculated and is presented in the table to quantify the volume of the Company’s derivative activity. Notional amounts are not necessarily reflective of credit risk. The following tables exclude investments that contain an embedded credit derivative for which the Company has elected the fair value option. For further discussion, see the Fair Value Option section in Note 4 - Fair Value Measurements of Notes to Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements.

42

Table of Contents
THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)
5. Investments and Derivative Instruments (continued)

 
Net Derivatives
 
Asset Derivatives
 
Liability Derivatives
 
Notional Amount
 
Fair Value
 
Fair Value
 
Fair Value
Hedge Designation/ Derivative Type
Mar. 31, 2015
Dec. 31, 2014
 
Mar. 31, 2015
Dec. 31, 2014
 
Mar. 31, 2015
Dec. 31, 2014
 
Mar. 31, 2015
Dec. 31, 2014
Cash flow hedges
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Interest rate swaps
$
4,001

$
3,999

 
$
100

$
44

 
$
101

$
52

 
$
(1
)
$
(8
)
Foreign currency swaps
143

143

 
(27
)
(19
)
 
6

3

 
(33
)
(22
)
Total cash flow hedges
4,144

4,142

 
73

25

 
107

55

 
(34
)
(30
)
Fair value hedges
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Interest rate swaps
66

32

 


 


 


Total fair value hedges
66

32

 


 


 


Non-qualifying strategies
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Interest rate contracts
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Interest rate swaps and futures
15,295

15,254

 
(501
)
(512
)
 
718

536

 
(1,219
)
(1,048
)
Foreign exchange contracts
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Foreign currency swaps and forwards
179

177

 
8

1

 
9

3

 
(1
)
(2
)
Japan fixed payout annuity hedge
1,319

1,319

 
(441
)
(427
)
 


 
(441
)
(427
)
Credit contracts
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Credit derivatives that purchase credit protection
197

595

 
(3
)
(6
)
 

4

 
(3
)
(10
)
Credit derivatives that assume credit risk [1]
1,863

1,487

 
8

3

 
21

14

 
(13
)
(11
)
Credit derivatives in offsetting positions
5,150

5,343

 
(3
)
(3
)
 
49

53

 
(52
)
(56
)
Equity contracts
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Equity index swaps and options
541

635

 
4

2

 
34

31

 
(30
)
(29
)
Commodity contracts
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Commodity options
582


 
10


 
10


 


Variable annuity hedge program
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
GMWB product derivatives [2]
17,079

17,908

 
(176
)
(139
)
 


 
(176
)
(139
)
GMWB reinsurance contracts
3,514

3,659

 
65

56

 
65

56

 


GMWB hedging instruments
12,179

14,442

 
181

174

 
309

289

 
(128
)
(115
)
Macro hedge program
7,742

6,383

 
187

141

 
227

180

 
(40
)
(39
)
Other
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Contingent capital facility put option
500

500

 
11

12

 
11

12

 


Modified coinsurance reinsurance contracts
963

974

 
22

34

 
22

34

 


Total non-qualifying strategies
67,103

68,676

 
(628
)
(664
)
 
1,475

1,212

 
(2,103
)
(1,876
)
Total cash flow hedges, fair value hedges, and non-qualifying strategies
$
71,313

$
72,850

 
$
(555
)
$
(639
)
 
$
1,582

$
1,267

 
$
(2,137
)
$
(1,906
)
Balance Sheet Location
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Fixed maturities, available-for-sale
$
454

$
454

 
$
(2
)
$
2

 
$

$
2

 
$
(2
)
$

Other investments
22,729

23,014

 
445

364

 
659

624

 
(214
)
(260
)
Other liabilities
26,524

26,791

 
(883
)
(930
)
 
836

551

 
(1,719
)
(1,481
)
Reinsurance recoverables
4,477

4,633

 
87

90

 
87

90

 


Other policyholder funds and benefits payable
17,129

17,958

 
(202
)
(165
)
 


 
(202
)
(165
)
Total derivatives
$
71,313

$
72,850

 
$
(555
)
$
(639
)
 
$
1,582

$
1,267

 
$
(2,137
)
$
(1,906
)
[1]
The derivative instruments related to this strategy are held for other investment purposes.
[2]
These derivatives are embedded within liabilities and are not held for risk management purposes.

43

Table of Contents
THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)
5. Investments and Derivative Instruments (continued)

Change in Notional Amount
The net decrease in notional amount of derivatives since December 31, 2014 was primarily due to the following:
The decline in notional amount related to the GMWB hedging instruments, partially offset by an increase in notional amount related to the macro hedge program, was primarily driven by portfolio re-balancing.
Change in Fair Value
The net improvement in the total fair value of derivative instruments since December 31, 2014 was primarily related to the following:
The increase in the fair value of interest rate swaps was primarily due to a decrease in interest rates.
The increase in the fair value related to the macro hedge program was primarily driven by portfolio re-balancing.
These improvements in fair value were partially offset by a decrease in fair value related to the combined GMWB hedging program, which includes the GMWB product, reinsurance, and hedging derivatives, primarily driven by declining interest rates and volatility levels.
Offsetting of Derivative Assets/Liabilities
The following tables present the gross fair value amounts, the amounts offset, and net position of derivative instruments eligible for offset in the Company's Condensed Consolidated Balance Sheets. Amounts offset include fair value amounts, income accruals and related cash collateral receivables and payables associated with derivative instruments that are traded under a common master netting agreement, as described in the preceding discussion. Also included in the tables are financial collateral receivables and payables, which are contractually permitted to be offset upon an event of default, although are disallowed for offsetting under U.S. GAAP.
As of March 31, 2015
 
(i)
 
(ii)
 
(iii) = (i) - (ii)
(iv)
 
(v) = (iii) - (iv)
 
 
 
 
 
Net Amounts Presented in the Statement of Financial Position
 
Collateral Disallowed for Offset in the Statement of Financial Position
 
 
 
Gross Amounts of Recognized Assets
 
Gross Amounts Offset in the Statement of Financial Position
 
Derivative Assets [1]
 
Accrued Interest and Cash Collateral Received [2]
 
Financial Collateral Received [4]
 
Net Amount
Description
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Other investments
$
1,495

 
$
1,268

 
$
445

 
$
(218
)
 
$
138

 
$
89

 
Gross Amounts of Recognized Liabilities
 
Gross Amounts Offset in the Statement of Financial Position
 
Derivative Liabilities [3]
 
Accrued Interest and Cash Collateral Pledged [3]
 
Financial Collateral Pledged [4]
 
Net Amount
Description
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Other liabilities
$
(1,933
)
 
$
(946
)
 
$
(880
)
 
$
(107
)
 
$
(1,131
)
 
$
144


44

Table of Contents
THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)
5. Investments and Derivative Instruments (continued)

As of December 31, 2014
 
(i)
 
(ii)
 
(iii) = (i) - (ii)
(iv)
 
(v) = (iii) - (iv)
 
 
 
 
 
Net Amounts Presented in the Statement of Financial Position
 
Collateral Disallowed for Offset in the Statement of Financial Position
 
 
 
Gross Amounts of Recognized Assets
 
Gross Amounts Offset in the Statement of Financial Position
 
Derivative Assets [1]
 
Accrued Interest and Cash Collateral Received [2]
 
Financial Collateral Received [4]
 
Net Amount
Description
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Other investments
$
1,175

 
$
969

 
$
364

 
$
(158
)
 
$
109

 
$
97

 
Gross Amounts of Recognized Liabilities
 
Gross Amounts Offset in the Statement of Financial Position
 
Derivative Liabilities [3]
 
Accrued Interest and Cash Collateral Pledged [3]
 
Financial Collateral Pledged [4]
 
Net Amount
Description
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Other liabilities
$
(1,741
)
 
$
(799
)
 
$
(927
)
 
$
(15
)
 
$
(1,079
)
 
$
137

[1]
Included in other invested assets in the Company's Condensed Consolidated Balance Sheets.
[2]
Included in other assets in the Company's Condensed Consolidated Balance Sheets and is limited to the net derivative receivable associated with each counterparty.
[3]
Included in other liabilities in the Company's Condensed Consolidated Balance Sheets and is limited to the net derivative payable associated with each counterparty. Not included in this amount are embedded derivatives associated with consumer notes of $(3) as of March 31, 2015 and December 31, 2014, which were not eligible for offset in the Company's Condensed Consolidated Balance Sheets.
[4]
Excludes collateral associated with exchange-traded derivative instruments.
Cash Flow Hedges
For derivative instruments that are designated and qualify as cash flow hedges, the effective portion of the gain or loss on the derivative is reported as a component of OCI and reclassified into earnings in the same period or periods during which the hedged transaction affects earnings. Gains and losses on the derivative representing hedge ineffectiveness are recognized in current period earnings. All components of each derivative’s gain or loss were included in the assessment of hedge effectiveness.
The following tables present the components of the gain or loss on derivatives that qualify as cash flow hedges:
Derivatives in Cash Flow Hedging Relationships
 
Gain (Loss) Recognized in OCI on Derivative (Effective Portion)
Net Realized Capital Gains(Losses) Recognized in Income on Derivative (Ineffective Portion)
 
Three Months Ended March 31,
Three Months Ended March 31,
 
2015
2014
2015
2014
Interest rate swaps
$
56

$
44

$

$
(1
)
Foreign currency swaps
(7
)
(1
)


Total
$
49

$
43

$

$
(1
)
 
 
Gain or (Loss) Reclassified from AOCI into Income (Effective Portion)
 
 
Three Months Ended March 31,
 
Location
2015
2014
Interest rate swaps
Net realized capital gain (loss)
$
1

$
1

Interest rate swaps
Net investment income
16

23

Foreign currency swaps
Net realized capital gain (loss)
(10
)

Total
 
$
7

$
24


45

Table of Contents
THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)
5. Investments and Derivative Instruments (continued)

As of March 31, 2015 the before-tax deferred net gains on derivative instruments recorded in AOCI that are expected to be reclassified to earnings during the next twelve months are $44. This expectation is based on the anticipated interest payments on hedged investments in fixed maturity securities that will occur over the next twelve months, at which time the Company will recognize the deferred net gains (losses) as an adjustment to net investment income over the term of the investment cash flows. The maximum term over which the Company is hedging its exposure to the variability of future cash flows for forecasted transactions, excluding interest payments on existing variable-rate financial instruments, is approximately three years.
During the three months ended March 31, 2015 and March 31, 2014 the Company had no net reclassifications from AOCI to earnings resulting from the discontinuance of cash-flow hedges due to forecasted transactions that were no longer probable of occurring.
Fair Value Hedges
For derivative instruments that are designated and qualify as a fair value hedge, the gain or loss on the derivative as well as the offsetting loss or gain on the hedged item attributable to the hedged risk are recognized in current period earnings. The Company includes the gain or loss on the derivative in the same line item as the offsetting loss or gain on the hedged item. All components of each derivative’s gain or loss were included in the assessment of hedge effectiveness.
The Company recognized in income gains (losses) representing the ineffective portion of fair value hedges as follows:
Derivatives in Fair Value Hedging Relationships
 
 
Gain or (Loss) Recognized in Income [1]
 
 
Three Months Ended March 31,
 
 
2015
 
2014
 
Location
Derivative
Hedge Item
 
Derivative
Hedge Item
Interest rate swaps
Net realized capital gain/(loss)
$

$

 
$
(1
)
$

[1]
The amounts presented do not include the periodic net coupon settlements of the derivative or the coupon income (expense) related to the hedged item. The net of the amounts presented represents the ineffective portion of the hedge.

46

Table of Contents
THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)
5. Investments and Derivative Instruments (continued)

Non-qualifying Strategies
For non-qualifying strategies, including embedded derivatives that are required to be bifurcated from their host contracts and accounted for as derivatives, the gain or loss on the derivative is recognized currently in earnings within net realized capital gains (losses). The following table presents the gain or loss recognized in income on non-qualifying strategies:
Derivatives Used in Non-Qualifying Strategies
Gain or (Loss) Recognized within Net Realized Capital Gains and Losses
 
Three Months Ended March 31,
 
2015
2014
Interest rate contracts
 
 
Interest rate swaps and forwards
$
(12
)
$
(57
)
Foreign exchange contracts
 
 
Foreign currency swaps and forwards
7

(2
)
Japan fixed payout annuity hedge [1]
(14
)
15

Credit contracts
 
 
Credit derivatives that purchase credit protection
(2
)
(4
)
Credit derivatives that assume credit risk
9

(1
)
Equity contracts
 
 
Equity index swaps and options
(3
)

Commodity contracts
 
 
Commodity options
(5
)

Variable annuity hedge program
 
 
GMWB product derivatives
(19
)
36

GMWB reinsurance contracts
7

(4
)
GMWB hedging instruments
13

(17
)
Macro hedge program
(4
)
(10
)
Other
 
 
Contingent capital facility put option
(2
)
(1
)
Modified coinsurance reinsurance contracts
(11
)
(19
)
Total [2]
$
(36
)
$
(64
)
[1]
Not included in this amount is the associated liability adjustment for changes in foreign exchange spot rates through realized capital gains of $0 and $(28) for the three months ended March 31, 2015 and 2014, respectively.
[2]
Excludes investments that contain an embedded credit derivative for which the Company has elected the fair value option. For further discussion, see the Fair Value Option section in Note 4 - Fair Value Measurements.
For the three months ended March 31, 2015 the net realized capital gain (loss) related to derivatives used in non-qualifying strategies was primarily comprised of the following:
The loss on the GMWB product derivatives was largely driven by a decline in interest rates and changes in volatility levels, offset by an increase in equity markets. These losses were offset by gains on the GMWB reinsurance contracts and GMWB hedging instruments.
The net loss related to the Japan fixed annuity payout hedge was primarily driven by a decline in U.S. interest rates.
The net loss related to interest rate derivatives was primarily due to a decline in U.S. interest rates.
The loss associated with modified coinsurance reinsurance contracts, which are accounted for as embedded derivatives and transfer to the reinsurer the investment experience related to the assets supporting the reinsured policies, was primarily driven by a decline in long-term interest rates during the period. The assets remain on the Company's books and the Company recorded an offsetting gain in OCI as a result of the increase in market value of the bonds.
In addition, for the three months ended March 31, 2015, and 2014 the Company recognized gains of $0 and $7, respectively, due to cash recovered on derivative receivables that were previously written-off related to the bankruptcy of Lehman Brothers Inc. The derivative receivables were the result of the contractual collateral threshold amounts and open collateral calls prior to the bankruptcy filing as well as interest rate and credit spread movements from the date of the last collateral call to the date of the bankruptcy filing.

47

Table of Contents
THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)
5. Investments and Derivative Instruments (continued)

For the three months ended March 31, 2014 the net realized capital gain (loss) related to derivatives used in non-qualifying strategies was primarily comprised of the following:
The net loss related to interest rate contracts was primarily driven by a decline in U.S. interest rates.
The net loss on the macro hedge program was primarily due to decreased volatility and an improvement in domestic equity markets.
The loss associated with modified coinsurance reinsurance contracts, which are accounted for as embedded derivatives and transfer to the reinsurer the investment experience related to the assets supporting the reinsured policies, was primarily driven by a decline in long-term interest rates during the period. The assets remain on the Company's books and the Company recorded an offsetting gain in OCI as a result of the increase in market value of the bonds.
The net gain related to the combined GMWB hedging program, which includes the GMWB product, reinsurance, and hedging derivatives, was primarily due to outperformance of underlying actively managed funds compared to their respective indices.
For additional disclosures regarding contingent credit related features in derivative agreements, see Note 8 - Commitments and Contingencies of Notes to Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements.
Credit Risk Assumed through Credit Derivatives
The Company enters into credit default swaps that assume credit risk of a single entity or referenced index in order to synthetically replicate investment transactions that would be permissible investments under the Company's investment policies. The Company will receive periodic payments based on an agreed upon rate and notional amount and will only make a payment if there is a credit event. A credit event payment will typically be equal to the notional value of the swap contract less the value of the referenced security issuer’s debt obligation after the occurrence of the credit event. A credit event is generally defined as a default on contractually obligated interest or principal payments or bankruptcy of the referenced entity. The credit default swaps in which the Company assumes credit risk primarily reference investment grade single corporate issuers and baskets, which include standard diversified portfolios of corporate and CMBS issuers. The diversified portfolios of corporate issuers are established within sector concentration limits and may be divided into tranches that possess different credit ratings.
The following tables present the notional amount, fair value, weighted average years to maturity, underlying referenced credit obligation type and average credit ratings, and offsetting notional amounts and fair value for credit derivatives in which the Company is assuming credit risk as of March 31, 2015 and December 31, 2014.

48

Table of Contents
THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)
5. Investments and Derivative Instruments (continued)

As of March 31, 2015
 
 
 
 
Underlying Referenced Credit
Obligation(s) [1]
 
 
Credit Derivative type by derivative risk exposure
Notional
Amount
[2]
Fair
Value
Weighted
Average
Years to
Maturity
Type
Average
Credit
Rating
Offsetting
Notional
Amount [3]
Offsetting
Fair
Value [3]
Single name credit default swaps
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Investment grade risk exposure
$
252

$
4

2 years
Corporate Credit/
Foreign Gov.
BBB+
$
227

$
(4
)
Below investment grade risk exposure
29


2 years
Corporate Credit
BB
29

(1
)
Basket credit default swaps [4]
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Investment grade risk exposure
2,721

38

3 years
Corporate Credit
BBB+
1,898

(23
)
Below investment grade risk exposure
59

4

5 years
Corporate Credit
B+


Investment grade risk exposure
873

(12
)
6 years
CMBS Credit
AA+
267

2

Below investment grade risk exposure
154

(22
)
2 years
CMBS Credit
CCC+
154

21

Embedded credit derivatives
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Investment grade risk exposure
350

347

2 years
Corporate Credit
A+


Total [5]
$
4,438

$
359

 
 
 
$
2,575

$
(5
)
As of December 31, 2014
 
 
 
 
Underlying Referenced
Credit Obligation(s) [1]
 
 
Credit Derivative type by derivative risk exposure
Notional
Amount [2]
Fair
Value
Weighted
Average
Years to
Maturity
Type
Average
Credit
Rating
Offsetting
Notional
Amount [3]
Offsetting
Fair
Value [3]
Single name credit default swaps
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Investment grade risk exposure
$
320

$
5

2 years
Corporate Credit/
Foreign Gov.
BBB+
$
247

$
(5
)
Below investment grade risk exposure
29


2 years
Corporate Credit
BB
29

(1
)
Basket credit default swaps [4]
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Investment grade risk exposure
2,546

33

3 years
Corporate Credit
BBB
1,973

(25
)
Below investment grade risk exposure
38

(1
)
12 years
Corporate Credit
D


Investment grade risk exposure
722

(12
)
6 years
CMBS Credit
AA+
269

3

Below investment grade risk exposure
154

(22
)
2 years
CMBS Credit
CCC+
154

23

Embedded credit derivatives
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Investment grade risk exposure
350

342

2 years
Corporate Credit
A


Total [5]
$
4,159

$
345

 
 
 
$
2,672

$
(5
)
[1]
The average credit ratings are based on availability and the midpoint of the applicable ratings among Moody’s, S&P, Fitch and Morningstar. If no rating is available from a rating agency, then an internally developed rating is used.
[2]
Notional amount is equal to the maximum potential future loss amount. These derivatives are governed by agreements, clearing house rules and applicable law which include collateral posting requirements. There is no additional specific collateral related to these contracts or recourse provisions included in the contracts to offset losses.
[3]
The Company has entered into offsetting credit default swaps to terminate certain existing credit default swaps, thereby offsetting the future changes in value of, or losses paid related to, the original swap.
[4]
Includes $3.8 billion and $3.5 billion as of March 31, 2015 and December 31, 2014, respectively, of standard market indices of diversified portfolios of corporate and CMBS issuers referenced through credit default swaps. These swaps are subsequently valued based upon the observable standard market index.
[5]
Excludes investments that contain an embedded credit derivative for which the Company has elected the fair value option. For further discussion, see the Fair Value Option section in Note 4 - Fair Value Measurements.

49

Table of Contents
THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)
5. Investments and Derivative Instruments (continued)

Derivative Collateral Arrangements
The Company enters into various collateral arrangements in connection with its derivative instruments, which require both the pledging and accepting of collateral. As of March 31, 2015 and December 31, 2014, the Company pledged cash collateral associated with derivative instruments with a fair value of $137 and $120 as of March 31, 2015 and December 31, 2014, respectively, for which the collateral receivable has been primarily included within other assets on the Company's Condensed Consolidated Balance Sheets. The Company also pledged securities collateral associated with derivative instruments with a fair value of $1.1 billion and $1.1 billion, respectively, as of March 31, 2015 and December 31, 2014, which have been included in fixed maturities on the Consolidated Balance Sheets. The counterparties have the right to sell or re-pledge these securities.
As of March 31, 2015 and December 31, 2014, the Company accepted cash collateral associated with derivative instruments of $477 and $327, respectively, which was invested and recorded in the Consolidated Balance Sheets in fixed maturities and short-term investments with corresponding amounts recorded in other liabilities. The Company also accepted securities collateral as of March 31, 2015 and December 31, 2014 with a fair value of $138 and $109, respectively, of which the Company has the ability to sell or repledge $126 and $97, respectively. As of March 31, 2015 and December 31, 2014 the fair value of repledged securities totaled $0 and $0, respectively, and the Company did not sell any securities. In addition, as of March 31, 2015 and December 31, 2014 non-cash collateral accepted was held in separate custodial accounts and was not included in the Company’s Consolidated Balance Sheets.

50

Table of Contents
THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)
6. Separate Accounts, Death Benefits and Other Insurance Benefit Features

U.S. GMDB/GMWB, International GMDB/GMIB, and Universal Life Secondary Guarantee Benefits
Changes in the gross U.S. GMDB/GMWB, International GMDB/GMIB, and universal life secondary guarantee benefits are as follows:
 
U.S. GMDB/GMWB [1]
Universal Life Secondary Guarantees
Liability balance as of January 1, 2015
$
812

$
2,041

Incurred
41

66

Paid
(29
)

Unlock
(24
)
(3
)
Liability balance as of March 31, 2015
$
800

$
2,104

Reinsurance recoverable asset, as of January 1, 2015
$
481

$
2,041

Incurred
24

63

Paid
(22
)

Unlock
(6
)

Reinsurance recoverable asset, as of March 31, 2015
$
477

$
2,104

 
U.S. GMDB/GMWB [1]
International GMDB/GMIB
Universal Life Secondary Guarantees
Liability balance as of January 1, 2014
$
849

$
272

$
1,802

Incurred
46

15

56

Paid
(30
)
(8
)

Unlock
(11
)
3


Currency translation adjustment

6


Liability balance as of March 31, 2014
$
854

$
288

$
1,858

Reinsurance recoverable asset, as of January 1, 2014
$
533

$
23

$
1,802

Incurred
26

2

56

Paid
(22
)
(2
)

Unlock
(5
)
6


Reinsurance recoverable asset, as of March 31, 2014
$
532

$
29

$
1,858

[1]
These liability balances include all GMDB benefits, plus the life-contingent portion of GMWB benefits in excess of the return of the GRB. GMWB benefits up to the return of the GRB are embedded derivatives held at fair value and are excluded from these balances.

51

Table of Contents
THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)
6. Separate Accounts, Death Benefits and Other Insurance Benefit Features (continued)



The following table provides details concerning GMDB/GMWB exposure as of March 31, 2015:
Account Value by GMDB/GMWB Type
Maximum anniversary value (“MAV”) [1]
Account Value (“AV”) [8]
Net Amount at Risk (“NAR”) [9]
Retained Net Amount at Risk (“RNAR”) [9]
Weighted Average Attained Age of Annuitant
MAV only
$
16,577

$
2,519

$
379

70
With 5% rollup [2]
1,433

199

57

70
With Earnings Protection Benefit Rider (“EPB”) [3]
4,275

581

77

69
With 5% rollup & EPB
544

115

24

71
Total MAV
22,829

3,414

537

 
Asset Protection Benefit (“APB”) [4]
14,304

195

128

68
Lifetime Income Benefit (“LIB”) — Death Benefit [5]
608

7

7

68
Reset [6] (5-7 years)
2,895

14

14

69
Return of Premium (“ROP”) [7]/Other
10,864

53

47

67
Subtotal Variable Annuity with GMDB/GMWB [10]
51,500

3,683

733

69
Less: General Account Value with GMDB/GMWB
3,951

 
 
 
Subtotal Separate Account Liabilities with GMDB
47,549

 
 
 
Separate Account Liabilities without GMDB
88,254

 
 
 
Total Separate Account Liabilities
$
135,803

 
 
 
[1]
MAV GMDB is the greatest of current AV, net premiums paid and the highest AV on any anniversary before age 80 years (adjusted for withdrawals).
[2]
Rollup GMDB is the greatest of the MAV, current AV, net premium paid and premiums (adjusted for withdrawals) accumulated at generally 5% simple interest up to the earlier of age 80 years or 100% of adjusted premiums.
[3]
EPB GMDB is the greatest of the MAV, current AV, or contract value plus a percentage of the contract’s growth. The contract’s growth is AV less premiums net of withdrawals, subject to a cap of 200% of premiums net of withdrawals.
[4]
APB GMDB is the greater of current AV or MAV, not to exceed current AV plus 25% times the greater of net premiums and MAV (each adjusted for premiums in the past 12 months).
[5]
LIB GMDB is the greatest of current AV; net premiums paid; or, for certain contracts, a benefit amount generally based on market performance that ratchets over time.
[6]
Reset GMDB is the greatest of current AV, net premiums paid and the most recent five to seven year anniversary AV before age 80 years (adjusted for withdrawals).
[7]
ROP GMDB is the greater of current AV or net premiums paid.
[8]
AV includes the contract holder’s investment in the separate account and the general account.
[9]
NAR is defined as the guaranteed benefit in excess of the current AV. RNAR represents NAR reduced for reinsurance. NAR and RNAR are highly sensitive to equity markets movements and increase when equity markets decline.
[10]
Some variable annuity contracts with GMDB also have a life-contingent GMWB that may provide for benefits in excess of the return of the GRB. Such contracts included in this amount have $8.2 billion of total account value and weighted average attained age of 70 years. There is no NAR or retained NAR related to these contracts.
In the U.S., account balances of contracts with guarantees were invested in variable separate accounts as follows:
Asset type
As of March 31, 2015
As of December 31, 2014
Equity securities (including mutual funds)
$
43,532

$
44,786

Cash and cash equivalents
4,017

4,066

Total
$
47,549

$
48,852

As of March 31, 2015 and December 31, 2014, approximately 17% of the equity securities in the preceding table were funds invested in fixed income securities and approximately 83% were funds invested in equity securities.
For further information on guaranteed living benefits that are accounted for at fair value, such as GMWB, see Note 4 - Fair Value Measurements of Notes to Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements.

52

Table of Contents
THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)
7. Income Taxes


Income Taxes
A reconciliation of the tax provision at the U.S. federal statutory rate to the provision (benefit) for income taxes is as follows:
 
Three Months Ended March 31,
 
2015
2014
Tax provision at U.S. federal statutory rate
$
219

$
213

Tax-exempt interest
(34
)
(35
)
Dividends-received deduction ("DRD")
(23
)
(27
)
Valuation allowance
(1
)

Other
(3
)
(8
)
Provision for income taxes
$
158

$
143

The separate account DRD is estimated for the current year using information from the most recent return, adjusted for current year equity market performance and other appropriate factors, including estimated levels of corporate dividend payments and level of policy owner equity account balances. The actual current year DRD can vary from estimates based on, but not limited to, changes in eligible dividends received in the mutual funds, amounts of distribution from these mutual funds, amounts of short-term capital gains at the mutual fund level and the Company’s taxable income before the DRD. The Company evaluates its DRD computations on a quarterly basis.
Net deferred income taxes include the future tax benefits associated with the net operating loss carryover, foreign tax credit carryover, capital loss carryover, and alternative minimum tax credit carryover as follows:
 
As of
 
 
March 31, 2015
December 31, 2014
Expiration
 
Carryover amount
Expected tax benefit, gross
Carryover amount
Expected tax benefit, gross
Dates
Amount
Net operating loss carryover
$
5,485

$
1,915

$
5,547

$
1,936

2016
-
2017
$
3

 
 
 
 
 
2023
-
2033
$
5,482

Foreign tax credit carryover
$
180

$
180

$
178

$
178

2018
-
2025
$
180

Capital loss carryover
$
494

$
173

$
491

$
172

2019
$
491

 
 
 
 
 
2020
$
3

Alternative minimum tax credit carryover
$
652

$
652

$
652

$
652

No expiration
$

Net operating loss carryover
As of March 31, 2015 and December 31, 2014, the net deferred tax asset included the expected tax benefit attributable to net operating losses of $5,485 and $5,547, respectively, consisting of U.S. losses of $5,451 and $5,508, respectively, and foreign losses of $34 and $39. If unutilized, the U.S. losses expire as follows: $3 from 2016-2017, $5,482 from 2023-2033. Utilization of these loss carryovers is dependent upon the generation of sufficient future taxable income. Due to limitations on the use of certain losses, a valuation allowance of $8 has been established as of March 31, 2015 and $9 as of December 31, 2014 in order to recognize only the portion of net operating losses that will more likely than not be realized.
Most of the net operating loss carryover originated from the Company's U.S. and international annuity business, including from the hedging program. Given the sale of the Japan subsidiary in June 2014, and continued runoff of the U.S. fixed and variable annuity business, the exposure to taxable losses from the Talcott Resolution business is significantly lessened. Given the expected earnings of its property and casualty, group benefits and mutual fund businesses, the Company expects to generate sufficient taxable income in the future to utilize its net operating loss carryover net of the recorded valuation allowance. Although the Company projects there will be sufficient future taxable income to fully recover the remainder of the loss carryover, the Company's estimate of the likely realization may change over time.

53

Table of Contents
THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)
7. Income Taxes (continued)


Alternative minimum tax credit and foreign tax credit carryover
As of March 31, 2015 and December 31, 2014, the net deferred tax asset included the expected tax benefit attributable to alternative minimum tax credit carryover of $652 and $652, respectively, and foreign tax credit carryover of $180 and $178, respectively. The alternative minimum tax credits have no expiration date and the foreign tax credit carryover expire from 2018-2025. These credits are available to offset regular federal income taxes from future taxable income and although the Company believes there will be sufficient future regular federal taxable income, there can be no certainty that future events will not affect the ability to utilize the credits. Additionally, the use of the foreign tax credits generally depends on the generation of sufficient taxable income to first utilize all U.S. net operating loss carryover. However, the Company has identified and begun to purchase certain investments which allow for utilization of the foreign tax credits without first using the net operating loss carryover. Consequently, the Company believes it is more likely than not the foreign tax credit carryover will be fully realized. Accordingly, no valuation allowance has been provided on either the alternative minimum tax carryover or foreign tax credit carryover.
Capital loss carryover
As of March 31, 2015 and December 31, 2014, the net deferred tax asset included the expected tax benefit attributable to the capital loss carryover of $494 and $491, respectively. The capital loss carryover is largely due to the loss on sale of the Company’s Japan subsidiary, HLIKK. If unutilized, $491 of the capital loss carryover will expire in 2019 and $3 in 2020. Utilization of the capital loss carryover requires the Company to realize sufficient taxable capital gains. While the Company has some ability to utilize the capital loss carryover by generating capital gains through tax planning strategies, the Company concluded that it is more likely than not that this asset will not be realized and, accordingly, in 2014, the Company recorded a valuation allowance of $172 through discontinued operations.
The Company’s unrecognized tax benefits were unchanged during the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013, and 2012, remaining at $48 as of March 31, 2015 and December 31, 2014. This entire amount, if it were recognized, would affect the effective tax rate in the period it is released.
The Company is no longer subject to U.S. federal, state and local, or non-U.S. income tax examinations for years prior to 2007. The federal audit of the years 2007-2011 is expected to conclude in 2015 and it is reasonably possible the Company may be able to reduce part of or the entire amount of the unrecognized tax benefits within the next 12 months. Apart from the possible reduction in unrecognized tax benefits, management does not expect the conclusion of the federal audit for the 2007-2011 years will have a material impact on the consolidated financial condition or results of operations. The federal audit of the years 2012 and 2013 began in March 2015 and is expected to be completed in 2016. Management believes that adequate provision has been made in the financial statements for any potential assessments that may result from tax examinations and other tax-related matters for all open tax years.

54

Table of Contents
THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)
8. Commitments and Contingencies

Litigation
The Hartford is involved in claims litigation arising in the ordinary course of business, both as a liability insurer defending or providing indemnity for third-party claims brought against insureds and as an insurer defending coverage claims brought against it. The Hartford accounts for such activity through the establishment of unpaid loss and loss adjustment expense reserves. Subject to the uncertainties in the following discussion under the caption “Asbestos and Environmental Claims,” management expects that the ultimate liability, if any, with respect to such ordinary-course claims litigation, after consideration of provisions made for potential losses and costs of defense, will not be material to the consolidated financial condition, results of operations or cash flows of The Hartford.
The Hartford is also involved in other kinds of legal actions, some of which assert claims for substantial amounts. These actions include, among others, and in addition to the matters in the following discussion, putative state and federal class actions seeking certification of a state or national class. Such putative class actions have alleged, for example, underpayment of claims or improper underwriting practices in connection with various kinds of insurance policies, such as personal and commercial automobile, property, disability, life and inland marine. The Hartford also is involved in individual actions in which punitive damages are sought, such as claims alleging bad faith in the handling of insurance claims or other allegedly unfair or improper business practices. Like many other insurers, The Hartford also has been joined in actions by asbestos plaintiffs asserting, among other things, that insurers had a duty to protect the public from the dangers of asbestos and that insurers committed unfair trade practices by asserting defenses on behalf of their policyholders in the underlying asbestos cases. Management expects that the ultimate liability, if any, with respect to such lawsuits, after consideration of provisions made for estimated losses, will not be material to the consolidated financial condition of The Hartford. Nonetheless, given the large or indeterminate amounts sought in certain of these actions, and the inherent unpredictability of litigation, the outcome in certain matters could, from time to time, have a material adverse effect on the Company’s results of operations or cash flows in particular quarterly or annual periods.
Apart from the inherent difficulty of predicting litigation outcomes, the following Mutual Funds Litigation discussion purports to seek substantial damages for unsubstantiated conduct spanning a multi-year period based on novel applications of complex legal theories. The alleged damages are not quantified or factually supported in the complaint, and, in any event, the Company’s experience shows that demands for damages often bear little relation to a reasonable estimate of potential loss. The matter is in the earliest stages of litigation, with no substantive legal decisions by the court defining the scope of the claims or the potentially available damages; fact discovery is also in its early stages. Accordingly, management cannot reasonably estimate the possible loss or range of loss, if any.
Mutual Funds Litigation — In February 2011, a derivative action was brought on behalf of six Hartford retail mutual funds in the United States District Court for the District of New Jersey, alleging that Hartford Investment Financial Services, LLC (“HIFSCO”), an indirect subsidiary of the Company, received excessive advisory and distribution fees in violation of its statutory fiduciary duty under Section 36(b) of the Investment Company Act of 1940. HIFSCO moved to dismiss and, in September 2011, the motion was granted in part and denied in part, with leave to amend the complaint. In November 2011, plaintiffs filed an amended complaint on behalf of The Hartford Global Health Fund, The Hartford Conservative Allocation Fund, The Hartford Growth Opportunities Fund, The Hartford Inflation Plus Fund, The Hartford Advisors Fund, and The Hartford Capital Appreciation Fund. Plaintiffs seek to rescind the investment management agreements and distribution plans between HIFSCO and these funds and to recover the total fees charged thereunder or, in the alternative, to recover any improper compensation HIFSCO received, in addition to lost earnings. HIFSCO filed a partial motion to dismiss the amended complaint and, in December 2012, the court dismissed without prejudice the claims regarding distribution fees and denied the motion with respect to the advisory fees claims. In March 2014, the plaintiffs filed a new complaint that, among other things, added as new plaintiffs The Hartford Floating Rate Fund and The Hartford Small Company Fund and named as a defendant Hartford Funds Management Company, LLC (“HFMC”), an indirect subsidiary of the Company which assumed the role as advisor to the funds as of January 2013. In March 2015, the plaintiffs filed a new complaint that, among other things, removed The Hartford Small Company Fund as a plaintiff. Discovery is ongoing. HFMC and HIFSCO dispute the allegations and expect to file a motion for summary judgment in the second quarter of 2015.
Asbestos and Environmental Claims – As discussed in Item 2, Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations - Critical Accounting Estimates - Property and Casualty Insurance Product Reserves, Net of Reinsurance - Property & Casualty Other Operations Claims, The Hartford continues to receive asbestos and environmental claims that involve significant uncertainty regarding policy coverage issues. Regarding these claims, The Hartford continually reviews its overall reserve levels and reinsurance coverages, as well as the methodologies it uses to estimate its exposures. Because of the significant uncertainties that limit the ability of insurers and reinsurers to estimate the ultimate reserves necessary for unpaid losses and related expenses, particularly those related to asbestos, the ultimate liabilities may exceed the currently recorded reserves. Any such additional liability cannot be reasonably estimated now but could be material to The Hartford’s consolidated operating results and liquidity.

55

Table of Contents
THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)
8. Commitments and Contingencies (continued)

Derivative Commitments
Certain of the Company’s derivative agreements contain provisions that are tied to the financial strength ratings of the individual legal entity that entered into the derivative agreement as set by nationally recognized statistical rating agencies. If the legal entity’s financial strength were to fall below certain ratings, the counterparties to the derivative agreements could demand immediate and ongoing full collateralization and in certain instances demand immediate settlement of all outstanding derivative positions traded under each impacted bilateral agreement. The settlement amount is determined by netting the derivative positions transacted under each agreement. If the termination rights were to be exercised by the counterparties, it could impact the legal entity’s ability to conduct hedging activities by increasing the associated costs and decreasing the willingness of counterparties to transact with the legal entity. The aggregate fair value of all derivative instruments with credit-risk-related contingent features that are in a net liability position as of March 31, 2015 is $1.1 billion. Of this $1.1 billion the legal entities have posted collateral of $1.3 billion in the normal course of business. In addition, the Company has posted collateral of $39 associated with a customized GMWB derivative. Based on derivative market values as of March 31, 2015 a downgrade of one level below the current financial strength ratings by either Moody’s or S&P could require approximately an additional $1 to be posted as collateral. Based on derivative market values as of March 31, 2015 a downgrade by either Moody’s or S&P of two levels below the legal entities’ current financial strength ratings could require approximately an additional $8 of assets to be posted as collateral. These collateral amounts could change as derivative market values change, as a result of changes in our hedging activities or to the extent changes in contractual terms are negotiated. The nature of the collateral that we would post, if required, would be primarily in the form of U.S. Treasury bills, U.S. Treasury notes and government agency securities.
9. Equity
Capital Purchase Program ("CPP") Warrants
As of March 31, 2015 and December 31, 2014, respectively, the Company has 6.6 million and 7.2 million CPP warrants outstanding and exercisable. CPP warrant exercises were 0.6 million and 9.8 million during the three months ended March 31, 2015 and 2014, respectively.
The declaration of common stock dividends by the Company in excess of a threshold triggers a provision in the Company's warrant agreement with The Bank of New York Mellon resulting in adjustments to the CPP warrant exercise price. Accordingly, the declaration of a common stock dividend during the three months ended March 31, 2015 resulted in an adjustment to the CPP warrant exercise price. The CPP warrant exercise price was $9.358 as of March 31, 2015 and $9.388 as of December 31, 2014.
Equity Repurchase Program
The Company's total authorization for equity repurchases is $2.775 billion for the period January 1, 2014 through December 31, 2015, with $729 remaining as of March 31, 2015.
During the three months ended March 31, 2015, the Company repurchased 6.1 million common shares for $250. During the period April 1, 2015 to April 22, 2015, the Company repurchased 1.5 million common shares for $65.

56

Table of Contents
THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)
10. Changes in and Reclassifications From Accumulated Other Comprehensive Income

Changes in AOCI, net of tax and DAC, by component for the three months ended March 31, 2015 consist of the following:
Three months ended March 31, 2015
 
Net Unrealized Gain on Securities
OTTI Losses in OCI
Net Gain on Cash Flow Hedging Instruments
Foreign Currency Translation Adjustments
Pension and Other Postretirement Plan Adjustments
Total AOCI
Beginning balance
$
2,370

$
(5
)
$
150

$
(8
)
$
(1,579
)
$
928

OCI before reclassifications
232

(4
)
32

(20
)
19

259

Amounts reclassified from AOCI
(24
)
1

(5
)

(9
)
(37
)
Net OCI
208

(3
)
27

(20
)
10

222

Ending balance
$
2,578

$
(8
)
$
177

$
(28
)
$
(1,569
)
$
1,150

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Reclassifications from AOCI for the three months ended March 31, 2015 consist of the following:
AOCI
Amount Reclassified from AOCI
Affected Line Item in the Condensed Consolidated Statement of Operations
 
Three months ended March 31, 2015
 
Net Unrealized Gain on Securities
 
 
Available-for-sale securities
$
37

Net realized capital gains (losses)
 
37

Total before tax
 
13

Income tax expense
 
$
24

Net income (loss)
OTTI Losses in OCI
 
 
Other than temporary impairments
$
(1
)
Net realized capital gains (losses)
 
(1
)
Total before tax
 

Income tax expense (benefit)
 
$
(1
)
Net income (loss)
Net Gains on Cash Flow Hedging Instruments
 
 
Interest rate swaps
$
1

Net realized capital gains (losses)
Interest rate swaps
16

Net investment income
Foreign currency swaps
(10
)
Net realized capital gains (losses)
 
7

Total before tax
 
2

Income tax expense
 
$
5

Net income (loss)
Pension and Other Postretirement Plan Adjustments
 
 
Amortization of prior service credit
$
(2
)
Insurance operating costs and other expenses
Amortization of actuarial loss
$
16

Insurance operating costs and other expenses
 
14

Total before tax
 
5

Income tax expense
 
9

Net income (loss)
Total amounts reclassified from AOCI
$
37

Net income (loss)

57

Table of Contents
THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)
10. Changes in and Reclassifications From Accumulated Other Comprehensive Income (continued)

Changes in AOCI, net of tax and DAC, by component for three months ended March 31, 2014 consist of the following:
Three months ended March 31, 2014
 
Net Unrealized Gain on Securities
OTTI Losses in OCI
Net Gain on Cash Flow Hedging Instruments
Foreign Currency Translation Adjustments
Pension and Other Postretirement Plan Adjustments
Total AOCI
Beginning balance
$
987

$
(12
)
$
108

$
91

$
(1,253
)
$
(79
)
OCI before reclassifications
717

3

29

17

13

779

Amounts reclassified from AOCI
(18
)
(1
)
(16
)

(6
)
(41
)
Net OCI
699

2

13

17

7

738

Ending balance
$
1,686

$
(10
)
$
121

$
108

$
(1,246
)
$
659

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Reclassifications from AOCI for the three months ended March 31, 2014 consist of the following:
AOCI
Amount Reclassified from AOCI
Affected Line Item in the Condensed Consolidated Statement of Operations
 
Three months ended March 31, 2014
 
Net Unrealized Gain on Securities
 
 
Available-for-sale securities
$
44

Net realized capital gains (losses)
 
44

Total before tax
 
15

Income tax expense
 
(11
)
Loss from discontinued operations, net of tax
 
$
18

Net income (loss)
OTTI Losses in OCI
 
 
Other than temporary impairments
$
2

Net realized capital gains (losses)
 
2

Total before tax
 
1

Income tax expense (benefit)
 
$
1

Net income (loss)
Net Gains on Cash Flow Hedging Instruments
 
 
Interest rate swaps
$
1

Net realized capital gains (losses)
Interest rate swaps
23

Net investment income
Foreign currency swaps

Net realized capital gains (losses)
 
24

Total before tax
 
8

Income tax expense
 
$
16

Net income (loss)
Pension and Other Postretirement Plan Adjustments
 
 
Amortization of prior service credit
$
(2
)
Insurance operating costs and other expenses
Amortization of actuarial loss
12

Insurance operating costs and other expenses
 
10

Total before tax
 
4

Income tax expense
 
6

Net income (loss)
Total amounts reclassified from AOCI
$
41

Net income (loss)


58

Table of Contents
THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)
11. Employee Benefit Plans

The Company’s employee benefit plans are described in Note 17 - Employee Benefit Plans of Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements included in The Hartford’s 2014 Annual Report on Form 10-K.
Components of Net Periodic Cost Benefit
Net periodic cost (benefit) includes the following components:
 
Pension Benefits
 
Other Postretirement Benefits
 
Three Months Ended March 31,
 
Three Months Ended March 31,
 
2015
2014
 
2015
2014
Interest cost
$
59

$
64

 
$
3

$
3

Expected return on plan assets
(78
)
(81
)
 
(3
)
(4
)
Amortization of prior service credit


 
(2
)
(2
)
Amortization of actuarial loss
15

11

 
1

1

Net periodic benefit
$
(4
)
$
(6
)
 
$
(1
)
$
(2
)
 
 
 
 
 
 

59

Table of Contents
THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)
12. Discontinued Operations



On June 30, 2014, the Company completed the sale of all of the issued and outstanding equity of Hartford Life Insurance KK, a Japanese company, to ORIX Life Insurance Corporation ("Buyer"), a subsidiary of ORIX Corporation, a Japanese company for cash proceeds of $963. The operations of the Company's Japan business meet the criteria for reporting as discontinued operations. The Company's Japan business is included in the Talcott Resolution reporting segment.
Concurrently with the sale, HLIKK recaptured certain risks that had been reinsured to the Company’s U.S. subsidiaries, Hartford Life and Annuity Insurance Company ("HLAI") and Hartford Life Insurance Company ("HLIC") by terminating intercompany agreements. Upon closing, the Buyer became responsible for all liabilities for the recaptured business. The Company has, however, continued to provide reinsurance for approximately $770 of Japan fixed payout annuities as of March 31, 2015.
The following table summarizes the amounts related to discontinued operations in the Condensed Consolidated Statements of Operations.
 
Three Months Ended March 31,
 
2014
Revenues
 
Earned premiums
$
(1
)
Fee income
125

Net investment income:
 
  Securities available-for-sale and other
12

  Equity securities, trading
(236
)
     Total net investment income
(224
)
Net realized capital losses
(51
)
Total revenues
(151
)
Benefits, losses and expenses
 
Benefits losses and loss adjustment expenses
28

Benefits, losses and loss adjustment expenses - returns credited on international variable annuities
(236
)
Insurance operating costs and other expenses
11

Total benefits, losses and expenses
(197
)
Income before income taxes
46

Income tax expense
17

Income from discontinued operations, net of tax
$
29

13. Subsequent Events
On April 24, 2015 the Company announced that it will redeem for cash the entire $296 aggregate principal amount outstanding of 4.000% senior notes due October 15, 2017 (the "2017 Notes") on May 27, 2015. The 2017 Notes will be redeemed at an estimated redemption price of approximately $320 including a make-whole premium and any interest accrued and unpaid to the redemption date. The Company expects to use cash on hand to finance the redemption.

60



Item 2. MANAGEMENT’S DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS OF FINANCIAL CONDITION
AND RESULTS OF OPERATIONS
(Dollar amounts in millions except share data unless otherwise stated)
The Hartford provides projections and other forward-looking information in the following discussions, which contain many forward-looking statements, particularly relating to the Company’s future financial performance. These forward-looking statements are estimates based on information currently available to the Company, are made pursuant to the safe harbor provisions of the Private Securities Litigation Reform Act of 1995 and are subject to the cautionary statements set forth on pages 3 and 4 of this Form 10-Q. Actual results are likely to differ, and in the past have differed, materially from those forecast by the Company, depending on the outcome of various factors, including, but not limited to, those set forth in each following discussion and in Part I, Item 1A, Risk Factors in The Hartford’s 2014 Form 10-K Annual Report. The Hartford undertakes no obligation to publicly update any forward-looking statements, whether as a result of new information, future developments or otherwise.
Certain reclassifications have been made to prior year financial information presented in Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations ("MD&A") to conform to the current year presentation. In 2014, the Company refined the definition of underwriting expenses by including certain centralized services and bad debt expenses in the determination of underwriting results for the Commercial Lines, Personal Lines and Property & Casualty Other Operations reporting segments. The reclassification of certain centralized services and bad debt expenses from other income (expenses) did not impact previously reported net income. This discussion should be read in conjunction with MD&A in The Hartford's 2014 Form 10-K Annual Report.
The Hartford defines increases or decreases greater than or equal to 200% as “NM” or not meaningful.
INDEX
Description
Page
Commercial Lines
Personal Lines


61



THE HARTFORD’S OPERATIONS
Overview
The Hartford is a financial holding company for a group of subsidiaries that provide property and casualty, group benefits and investment products to both individual and business customers in the United States and continues to administer life and annuity products previously sold.
The Hartford conducts business principally in six reporting segments including Commercial Lines, Personal Lines, Property & Casualty Other Operations, Group Benefits, Mutual Funds and Talcott Resolution, as well as a Corporate category. The Hartford includes in its Corporate category the Company’s debt financing and related interest expense, as well as other capital raising activities; and purchase accounting adjustments related to goodwill and other expenses not allocated to the reporting segments.
The Company derives its revenues principally from: (a) premiums earned for insurance coverages provided to insureds; (b) fee income, including asset management fees, on separate account and mutual fund assets and mortality and expense fees, as well as cost of insurance charges; (c) net investment income; (d) fees earned for services provided to third parties; and (e) net realized capital gains and losses. Premiums charged for insurance coverages are earned principally on a pro rata basis over the terms of the related policies in-force. Asset management fees and mortality and expense fees are primarily generated from separate account assets. Cost of insurance charges are assessed on the net amount at risk for investment-oriented life insurance products.
The profitability of the Company's property and casualty insurance businesses over time is greatly influenced by the Company’s underwriting discipline, which seeks to manage exposure to loss through favorable risk selection and diversification, its management of claims, its use of reinsurance, the size of its in force block, actual mortality and morbidity experience, and its ability to manage its expense ratio which it accomplishes through economies of scale and its management of acquisition costs and other underwriting expenses. Pricing adequacy depends on a number of factors, including the ability to obtain regulatory approval for rate changes, proper evaluation of underwriting risks, the ability to project future loss cost frequency and severity based on historical loss experience adjusted for known trends, the Company’s response to rate actions taken by competitors, and expectations about regulatory and legal developments and expense levels. The Company seeks to price its insurance policies such that insurance premiums and future net investment income earned on premiums received will cover underwriting expenses and the ultimate cost of paying claims reported on the policies and provide for a profit margin. For many of its insurance products, the Company is required to obtain approval for its premium rates from state insurance departments.
The financial results in the Company’s mutual fund and variable annuity businesses depend largely on the amount of the contract holder or shareholder account value or assets under management on which it earns fees and the level of fees charged. Changes in account value or assets under management are driven by two main factors: net flows, and the market return of the funds, which is heavily influenced by the return realized in the equity markets. Net flows are comprised of deposits less surrenders, death benefits, policy charges and annuitizations of investment type contracts, such as variable annuity contracts. In the mutual fund business, net flows are known as net sales. Net sales are comprised of new sales less redemptions by mutual fund customers. The Company uses the average daily value of the S&P 500 Index as an indicator for evaluating market returns of the underlying account portfolios in the United States. Financial results of variable products are highly correlated to the growth in account values or assets under management since these products generally earn fee income on a daily basis. Equity market movements could also result in benefits for or charges against deferred acquisition costs.
The profitability of fixed annuities and other “spread-based” products depends largely on the Company’s ability to earn target spreads between earned investment rates on its general account assets and interest credited to policyholders.
The investment return, or yield, on invested assets is an important element of the Company’s earnings since insurance products are priced with the assumption that premiums received can be invested for a period of time before benefits, loss and loss adjustment expenses are paid. Due to the need to maintain sufficient liquidity to satisfy claim obligations, the majority of the Company’s invested assets have been held in available-for-sale securities, including, among other asset classes, corporate bonds, municipal bonds, government debt, short-term debt, mortgage-backed securities and asset-backed securities.
The primary investment objective for the Company is to maximize economic value, consistent with acceptable risk parameters, including the management of credit risk and interest rate sensitivity of invested assets, while generating sufficient after-tax income to meet policyholder and corporate obligations. Investment strategies are developed based on a variety of factors including business needs, regulatory requirements and tax considerations.
For further information on the Company's reporting segments refer to Part I, Item 1, Business - Reporting Segments in The Hartford’s 2014 Form 10-K Annual Report.

62



Financial Highlights for the Three Months Ended March 31, 2015
Net income was $467, or $1.08 per diluted share, compared with net income of $495, or $1.03 per diluted share, in the comparable prior year period.
Common share repurchases totaled $250, or approximately 6.1 million shares, in the current quarter.
Book value per diluted common share (excluding AOCI) increased to $41.47 from $40.71 in the prior quarter due to the effect of net income less dividends and the effect of share repurchases in the quarter.
Net investment income decreased 2% to $809 compared to the prior year period due to lower income from fixed maturities as a result of lower reinvestment rates and a decrease in asset levels due to runoff of Talcott Resolution.
The annualized investment yield after-tax of 3.1% decreased slightly compared to the prior year period due to lower reinvestment rates reflecting the current interest rate environment. The new money yield decreased to 3.1% from 3.9%, compared to the prior year period, driven by lower interest rates.
Lower interest rates and tighter credit spreads increased the after-tax net unrealized gains in the investment portfolio by $208 in the current quarter.
Property & Casualty written premiums increased 2% over the comparable prior year period, comprised of 3% growth in Commercial Lines and 1% in Personal Lines.
Property & Casualty combined ratio, before catastrophes and prior year development, increased 2.1 points to 91.7 from 89.6 in the comparable prior year period. The first quarter of 2014 included a 2.0 point favorable impact related to a reduction in New York State Workers' Compensation Board assessments ("NY Assessments").
Catastrophe losses of $83, before tax, decreased from catastrophe losses of $86, before tax, in the comparable prior year period.
Favorable prior year development totaled $2, before tax, driven primarily by reserve releases related to favorable development in professional and general liability, and reserve releases related to 2014 catastrophes, partially offset by reserve strengthening in commercial auto liability.
Group Benefits after-tax core earnings margin, excluding buyouts, increased to 5.9% in the quarter from 5.1% in the comparable prior year period.
Talcott Resolution after-tax income from continuing operations was $111, compared with $116 in the comparable prior year period.

63



CONSOLIDATED RESULTS OF OPERATIONS
Operating Summary
Three Months Ended March 31,
 
2015
2014
Change
Earned premiums
$
3,322

$
3,302

1
%
Fee income
459

496

(7
%)
Net investment income
809

824

(2
%)
Net realized capital gains (losses)
5

(35
)
114
%
Other revenues
22

25

(12
%)
Total revenues
4,617

4,612

%
Benefits, losses and loss adjustment expenses
2,563

2,576

(1
%)
Amortization of deferred policy acquisition costs and present value of future profits (“DAC”)
387

396

(2
%)
Insurance operating costs and other expenses
948

936

1
%
Interest expense
94

95

(1
%)
Total benefits, losses and expenses
3,992

4,003

%
Income from continuing operations before income taxes
625

609

3
%
Income tax expense
158

143

10
%
Income from continuing operations, net of tax
467

466

%
Income from discontinued operations, net of tax

29

(100
%)
Net income
$
467

$
495

(6
%)
Three months ended March 31, 2015 compared to the three months ended March 31, 2014
Net income, compared to the prior year period, decreased for the three months ended March 31, 2015 primarily due to the net effect of the following items:
A $47 before tax decrease in current accident year underwriting results before catastrophes in Property & Casualty driven by a 2.1 point increase in the combined ratio before catastrophes and prior year development. Earned premiums increased 3% or $66, before tax, reflecting earned premium growth of 3% in both Commercial Lines and Personal Lines. Underwriting expenses in 2015 increased $77 due, in part, to a $49 benefit, before tax, in 2014 related to a reduction in NY Assessments, representing a 2.0 point favorable impact on the combined ratio in 2014. For a discussion of the Company's operating results by segment, see the segment sections of MD&A.
Prior accident year reserve release of $2, before tax, for the three months ended March 31, 2015, compared to a reserve release of $40, before tax, for the prior year period. Reserve releases in 2015 were primarily related to favorable development in professional and general liability, and reserve releases related to 2014 catastrophes, partially offset by reserve strengthening in commercial auto liability. Reserve releases in 2014 were primarily related to favorable development on accident year 2013 catastrophes and professional liability claims, and favorable development on accident year 2013 homeowners claims. For additional information, see MD&A - Critical Accounting Estimates, Reserve Roll Forwards and Development.
A decrease in income from discontinued operations of $29, net of tax, compared to the three months ended March 31, 2014. Income from discontinued operations in 2014 represents income from operations related to the Japan variable annuity business.
Net investment income of $809, before tax, for the three months ended March 31, 2015, decreased compared to $824, before tax, for the prior year period. The decrease in investment income was primarily due to lower income from fixed maturities as a result of lower reinvestment rates, as well as a decrease in asset levels, due to the runoff of Talcott Resolution. For further discussion of investment results, see MD&A - Investment Results, Net Investment Income (Loss).
Current accident year catastrophe losses of $83, before tax, for the three months ended March 31, 2015, compared to $86, before tax, for the prior year period. Catastrophe losses in both periods were primarily due to winter storm events across various U.S. geographic regions. For additional information, see MD&A - Critical Accounting Estimates, Property & Casualty Insurance Product Reserves, Net of Reinsurance.
Differences between the Company's effective income tax rate and the U.S. statutory rate of 35% are due primarily to tax-exempt interest earned on invested assets and the dividends received deduction ("DRD"). Income tax expense for the three months ended March 31, 2015 increased by $15 from $143 in the prior year period, primarily due to the $16, before tax, increase in income from continuing operations and the effect of permanent items. For further discussion of income taxes, see Note 7 - Income Taxes of Notes to Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements.

64



The following table presents net income (loss) for each reporting segment, as well as the Corporate category.
 
Three months ended March 31,
Net income (loss) by segment
2015
2014
Increase
(Decrease) From
2014 to 2015
Commercial Lines
$
240

$
242

$
(2
)
Personal Lines
76

99

(23
)
Property & Casualty Other Operations
23

22

1

Group Benefits
52

51

1

Mutual Funds
22

21

1

Talcott Resolution
111

145

(34
)
Corporate
(57
)
(85
)
28

Net income
$
467

$
495

$
(28
)
Investment Results
Composition of Invested Assets
 
March 31, 2015
 
December 31, 2014
 
Amount
Percent
 
Amount
Percent
Fixed maturities, available-for-sale ("AFS"), at fair value
$
60,555

79.1
%
 
$
59,384

77.9
%
Fixed maturities, at fair value using the fair value option ("FVO")
520

0.7
%
 
488

0.6
%
Equity securities, AFS, at fair value [1]
1,148

1.5
%
 
1,047

1.4
%
Mortgage loans
5,697

7.4
%
 
5,556

7.3
%
Policy loans, at outstanding balance
1,452

1.9
%
 
1,431

1.9
%
Limited partnerships and other alternative investments
2,923

3.8
%
 
2,942

3.9
%
Other investments [2]
630

0.8
%
 
547

0.7
%
Short-term investments
3,651

4.8
%
 
4,883

6.4
%
Total investments
$
76,576

100.0
%
 
$
76,278

100.0
%
[1]
Includes equity securities at fair value using the FVO of $402 and $348 as of March 31, 2015 and December 31, 2014, respectively.
[2]
Primarily relates to derivative instruments.
Total investments increased since December 31, 2014, primarily due to an increase in fixed maturities, AFS, mortgage loans and equity, AFS, partially offset by a decrease in short-term investments. The increase in fixed maturities, AFS and the decline in short-term investments are primarily the result of the reinvestment of short-term investments into longer dated fixed maturities. The increase in fixed maturities, AFS is also due to higher valuations as a result of a decline in interest rates, as well as the investment of proceeds received from repurchase agreements in U.S. Treasuries; for further information on repurchase agreements refer to Note 5 - Investments and Derivative Instruments of Notes to Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements.

65



Net Investment Income (Loss)
 
Three Months Ended March 31,
 
2015
2014
(Before-tax)
Amount
Yield [1]
Amount
Yield [1]
Fixed maturities [2]
$
600

4.2
%
$
616

4.2
%
Equity securities, AFS
6

2.0
%
7

3.3
%
Mortgage loans
69

4.9
%
66

4.7
%
Policy loans
20

5.6
%
20

5.7
%
Limited partnerships and other alternative investments
99

13.7
%
97

13.0
%
Other [3]
42

 
43

 
Investment expense
(27
)
 
(25
)
 
Total net investment income
809

4.5
%
824

4.5
%
Total net investment income excluding limited partnerships and other alternative investments
$
710

4.1
%
$
727

4.2
%
[1]
Yields calculated using annualized net investment income divided by the monthly average invested assets at cost, amortized cost, or adjusted carrying value, as applicable, excluding repurchase agreement collateral, if any, and derivatives book value. Yield calculations for each period exclude assets associated with the dispositions of Japan variable and fixed annuity business, as applicable.
[2]
Includes net investment income on short-term investments.
[3]
Primarily includes income from derivatives that qualify for hedge accounting and hedge fixed maturities.
Three months ended March 31, 2015 compared to the three months ended March 31, 2014
Total net investment income for the three months ended March 31, 2015 decreased in comparison to the three months ended March 31, 2014, primarily due to lower income from fixed maturities. The decrease in income related to fixed maturities is a result of lower reinvestment rates, as well as a decrease in asset levels, due to the runoff of Talcott Resolution.
The annualized net investment income yield, excluding limited partnerships and other alternative investments, has declined to 4.1% for the three months ended March 31, 2015 versus 4.2% for the comparable period in 2014. The decline was primarily attributable to lower reinvestment rates. The average reinvestment rate, excluding certain U.S. Treasury securities and cash equivalent securities, for the three months ended March 31, 2015, was approximately 3.1% which was below the average yield of sales and maturities of 4.1% for the same period, due to the current interest rate environment. For the first quarter of 2015, the new money yield decreased to 3.1% compared to 3.9% in the prior year period driven by lower interest rates. 
Based upon current reinvestment rates, we expect the annualized net investment income yield, excluding limited partnerships and other alternative investments, for 2015, to decline slightly from the current net investment income yield. The estimated impact on net investment income is subject to change as the composition of the portfolio changes through normal portfolio management and trading activities and changes in market conditions.

66



Net Realized Capital Gains (Losses)
 
Three Months Ended March 31,
(Before-tax)
2015
2014
Gross gains on sales
$
197

$
183

Gross losses on sales
(148
)
(129
)
Net other-than-temporary impairment ("OTTI") losses recognized in earnings
(12
)
(22
)
Valuation allowances on mortgage loans
(3
)

Periodic net coupon settlements on credit derivatives
1

(1
)
Results of variable annuity hedge program
 
 
GMWB derivatives, net
1

15

Macro hedge program
(4
)
(10
)
Total results of variable annuity hedge program
(3
)
5

Other, net [1]
(27
)
(71
)
Net realized capital gains
$
5

$
(35
)
[1]
Primarily consists of changes in value of non-qualifying derivatives, including interest rate derivatives used to manage duration, and the Japan fixed payout annuity hedge.
Details on the Company’s net realized capital gains and losses are as follows:
Gross gains and losses on sales
Gross gains on sales for the three months ended March 31, 2015 were primarily due to gains on the sale of industrial corporate and U.S. Treasury securities. Gross losses on sales for the three months ended March 31, 2015 were primarily the result of losses on the sale of corporate and foreign government and government agency securities, which included sales resulting from a reduction in our exposure to certain emerging market and energy sector securities, as well as other portfolio management activities. The sales were primarily a result of duration, liquidity and credit management, as well as tactical changes to the portfolio as a result of changing market conditions.
Gross gains on sales for the three months ended March 31, 2014 were primarily due to gains on the sale of corporate, CMBS, and RMBS. Gross losses on sales for the three months ended March 31, 2014 were the result of losses on sales of emerging market securities, primarily within the foreign government and corporate sectors. The sales were primarily a result of duration and liquidity management, as well as tactical changes to the portfolio as a result of changing market conditions.
Net OTTI losses
See Other-Than-Temporary Impairments within the Investment Portfolio Risks and Risk Management section of the MD&A.
Variable annuity hedge program
For the three months ended March 31, 2014 the gain related to the combined GMWB derivatives, net, which include the GMWB product, reinsurance, and hedging derivatives, was primarily driven by gains of $14 related to outperformance of underlying actively managed funds compared to their respective indices.
For the three months ended March 31, 2014 the loss on the macro hedge program was primarily due to losses of $9 related to decreased volatility and losses of $4 driven by an improvement in domestic equity markets.
Other, net
Other, net loss for the three months ended March 31, 2015 was primarily due to losses of $14 on Japan fixed payout annuity hedges primarily driven by a decline in U.S. interest rates, losses of $10 on interest rate derivatives due to a decline in interest rates, and losses of $11 associated with modified coinsurance reinsurance contracts. Modified coinsurance reinsurance contracts are accounted for as embedded derivatives and transfer to the reinsurer the investment experience related to the assets supporting the reinsured policies, primarily driven by a decline in long-term interest rates.
Other, net loss for the three months ended March 31, 2014 was primarily due to losses of $56 on interest derivatives due to a decline in U.S. interest rates, and losses of $13 on Japan fixed payout annuity hedges primarily driven by a decline in U.S. interest rates.

67



CRITICAL ACCOUNTING ESTIMATES
The preparation of financial statements, in conformity with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America (“U.S. GAAP”), requires management to make estimates and assumptions that affect the reported amounts of assets and liabilities and disclosure of contingent assets and liabilities at the date of the financial statements and the reported amounts of revenues and expenses during the reporting period. Actual results could differ, and in the past have differed, from those estimates.
The Company has identified the following estimates as critical in that they involve a higher degree of judgment and are subject to a significant degree of variability:
property and casualty insurance product reserves, net of reinsurance;
estimated gross profits used in the valuation and amortization of assets and liabilities associated with variable annuity and other universal life-type contracts;
evaluation of other-than-temporary impairments on available-for-sale securities and valuation allowances on mortgage loans;
living benefits required to be fair valued (in other policyholder funds and benefits payable);
goodwill impairment;
valuation of investments and derivative instruments;
valuation allowance on deferred tax assets; and
contingencies relating to corporate litigation and regulatory matters.
Certain of these estimates are particularly sensitive to market conditions, and deterioration and/or volatility in the worldwide debt or equity markets could have a material impact on the Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements. In developing these estimates, management makes subjective and complex judgments that are inherently uncertain and subject to material change as facts and circumstances develop. Although variability is inherent in these estimates, management believes the amounts provided are appropriate based upon the facts available upon compilation of the financial statements.
The Company’s critical accounting estimates are discussed in Part II, Item 7 MD&A in the Company’s 2014 Form 10-K Annual Report. The following discussion updates certain of the Company’s critical accounting estimates as of March 31, 2015.

68



Property & Casualty Insurance Product Reserves, Net of Reinsurance
Based on the results of the quarterly reserve review process, the Company determines the appropriate reserve adjustments, if any, to record. Recorded reserve estimates are adjusted after consideration of numerous factors, including but not limited to, the magnitude of the difference between the actuarial indication and the recorded reserves, improvement or deterioration of actuarial indications in the period, the maturity of the accident year, trends observed over the recent past and the level of volatility within a particular line of business. In general, adjustments are made more quickly to more mature accident years and less volatile lines of business. Such adjustments of reserves are referred to as “reserve development”. Reserve development that increases previous estimates of ultimate cost is called “reserve strengthening”. Reserve development that decreases previous estimates of ultimate cost is called “reserve releases”. Reserve development can influence the comparability of year over year underwriting results and is set forth in the paragraphs and tables that follow.
Reserve Roll Forwards and Development
A roll-forward of property and casualty insurance product liabilities for unpaid losses and loss adjustment expenses follows:
Three Months Ended March 31, 2015
 
Commercial
Lines [3]
Personal Lines
Property & Casualty Other Operations [3]
Total Property & Casualty Insurance
Beginning liabilities for unpaid losses and loss adjustment expenses, gross [3]
$
16,465

$
1,874

$
3,467

$
21,806

Reinsurance and other recoverables [3]
2,459

18

564

3,041

Beginning liabilities for unpaid losses and loss adjustment expenses, net [3]
14,006

1,856

2,903

18,765

Provision for unpaid losses and loss adjustment expenses
 
 
 
 
Current accident year before catastrophes
928

618


1,546

Current accident year catastrophes [4]
58

25


83

Prior accident years strengthening (release)
(2
)
(4
)
4

(2
)
Total provision for unpaid losses and loss adjustment expenses
984

639

4

1,627

Less: Payments
897

647

93

1,637

Ending liabilities for unpaid losses and loss adjustment expenses, net
14,093

1,848

2,814

18,755

Reinsurance and other recoverables
2,418

19

558

2,995

Ending liabilities for unpaid losses and loss adjustment expenses, gross
$
16,511

$
1,867

$
3,372

$
21,750

Earned premiums
$
1,583

$
952

 
 
Loss and loss expense paid ratio [1]
56.7

68.0

 
 
Loss and loss expense incurred ratio
62.2

67.1

 
 
Prior accident years development (pts) [2]
(0.1
)
(0.4
)
 
 
[1]
The “loss and loss expense paid ratio” represents the ratio of paid losses and loss adjustment expenses to earned premiums.
[2]
“Prior accident years development (pts)” represents the ratio of prior accident years development to earned premiums.
[3]
Hartford Financial Products International ("HFPI") gross reserves and reinsurance recoverables balances of $40 and $5, respectively, as of December 31, 2014 have been prospectively reclassified from Commercial Lines to Property & Casualty Other Operations as HFPI does not write new business.
[4]
Contributing to the current accident year catastrophes losses were the following events:
    
Three Months Ended March 31, 2015
Category
Commercial Lines
Personal Lines
Total Property & Casualty Insurance
Winter Storms [1]
$
49

$
17

$
66

Tornadoes
7

5

12

Wind and Hail
2

3

5

Total
$
58

$
25

$
83

[1] These amounts represent an aggregation of multiple catastrophes.

69



Prior accident years development recorded in 2015
Included within prior accident years development were the following reserve strengthenings (releases):
Three Months Ended March 31, 2015
 
Commercial Lines
Personal Lines
Property & Casualty Other Operations
Total Property & Casualty Insurance
Auto liability
$
25

$

$

$
25

Homeowners

1


1

Professional liability
(17
)


(17
)
Package business
1



1

General liability
(13
)


(13
)
Commercial property
(7
)


(7
)
Change in workers’ compensation discount, including accretion
8



8

Catastrophes
(6
)
(12
)

(18
)
Other reserve re-estimates, net
7

7

4

18

Total prior accident years development
$
(2
)
$
(4
)
$
4

$
(2
)
 
 
 
 
 
During the three months ended March 31, 2015, the Company’s re-estimates of prior accident years reserves included the following significant reserve changes:
Strengthened reserves in commercial auto liability primarily for accident years 2010 through 2013 due to increased frequency of large claims.
Released reserves in professional liability for accident years 2009 through 2011 primarily for large accounts. Claim costs for these accident years have emerged favorably as these years have matured and management has placed more weight on the emerged experience.
Released reserves in general liability primarily for accident years 2012 and 2013 due to lower frequency in late emerging claims.
Released catastrophe reserves primarily for accident year 2014 as fourth quarter 2014 catastrophes have developed favorably.

70



A roll-forward of property and casualty insurance product liabilities for unpaid losses and loss adjustment expenses follows:
Three Months Ended March 31, 2014
 
Commercial Lines
Personal Lines
Property & Casualty Other Operations
Total Property & Casualty Insurance
Beginning liabilities for unpaid losses and loss adjustment expenses, gross
$
16,293

$
1,864

$
3,547

$
21,704

Reinsurance and other recoverables
2,442

13

573

3,028

Beginning liabilities for unpaid losses and loss adjustment expenses, net
13,851

1,851

2,974

18,676

Provision for unpaid losses and loss adjustment expenses
 
 
 
 
Current accident year before catastrophes
934

590


1,524

Current accident year catastrophes [3]
60

26


86

Prior accident years strengthening (release)
(7
)
(34
)
1

(40
)
Total provision for unpaid losses and loss adjustment expenses
987

582

1

1,570

Less: Payments
912

613

120

1,645

Ending liabilities for unpaid losses and loss adjustment expenses, net
13,926

1,820

2,855

18,601

Reinsurance and other recoverables
2,469

15

567

3,051

Ending liabilities for unpaid losses and loss adjustment expenses, gross
$
16,395

$
1,835

$
3,422

$
21,652

Earned premiums
$
1,541

$
928

 
 
Loss and loss expense paid ratio [1]
59.2

66.1

 
 
Loss and loss expense incurred ratio
64.0

62.7

 
 
Prior accident years development (pts) [2]
(0.5
)
(3.7
)
 
 
[1]
The “loss and loss expense paid ratio” represents the ratio of paid losses and loss adjustment expenses to earned premiums.
[2]
“Prior accident years development (pts)” represents the ratio of prior accident years development to earned premiums.
[3]
Contributing to the current accident year catastrophes losses were the following events:
    
Three Months Ended March 31, 2014
Category
Commercial Lines
Personal Lines
Total Property & Casualty Insurance
Winter Storms [1]
$
55

$
18

$
73

Wind and Hail [1]
5

8

13

Total
$
60

$
26

$
86

[1] These amounts represent an aggregation of multiple catastrophes.

71



Prior accident years development recorded in 2014
Included within prior accident years development were the following reserve strengthenings (releases):
Three Months Ended March 31, 2014
 
Commercial Lines
Personal Lines
Property & Casualty Other Operations
Total Property & Casualty Insurance
Auto liability
$
5

$

$

$
5

Homeowners

(13
)

(13
)
Professional liability
(8
)


(8
)
Package business
(3
)


(3
)
Commercial property
(3
)


(3
)
Change in workers’ compensation discount, including accretion
8



8

Catastrophes
(12
)
(21
)

(33
)
Other reserve re-estimates, net
6


1

7

Total prior accident years development
$
(7
)
$
(34
)
$
1

$
(40
)
 
 
 
 
 
During the three months ended March 31, 2014, the Company’s re-estimates of prior accident years reserves included the following significant reserve changes:
Homeowner results emerged favorably for accident year 2013, primarily related to favorable development on fire and water-related claims in homeowners
Released reserves in professional liability for accident year 2013 due to lower frequency of reported claims.
Released reserves for accident year 2013 catastrophes as fourth quarter catastrophes have developed favorably.


72



Property & Casualty Other Operations Claims
Reserve Activity
Reserves and reserve activity in Property & Casualty Other Operations are categorized and reported as asbestos, environmental, or “all other”. The “all other” category of reserves covers a wide range of insurance and assumed reinsurance coverages, including, but not limited to, potential liability for construction defects, lead paint, silica, pharmaceutical products, molestation and other long-tail liabilities.
The following tables present reserve activity, inclusive of estimates for both reported and incurred but not reported claims, net of reinsurance, categorized by asbestos, environmental and all other claims.
Property & Casualty Other Operations Losses and Loss Adjustment Expenses
Three Months Ended March 31, 2015
Asbestos
 
Environmental
All Other [1] [2]
Total
Beginning liability—net [3][4]
$
1,710

  
$
241

$
952

$
2,903

Losses and loss adjustment expenses incurred

 
3

1

4

Less : losses and loss adjustment expenses paid
43

 
16

34

93

Ending liability – net [3][4]
$
1,667

[5] 
$
228

$
919

$
2,814

[1]
HFPI net reserves of $35 as of December 31, 2014 have been prospectively reclassified from Commercial Lines to "All Other" as HFPI does not write new business.
[2]
In addition to various insurance and assumed reinsurance exposures, “All Other” includes unallocated loss adjustment expense reserves. “All Other” also includes The Company's allowance for uncollectible reinsurance. When the Company commutes a ceded reinsurance contract or settles a ceded reinsurance dispute, the portion of the allowance for uncollectible reinsurance attributable to that commutation or settlement, if any, is reclassified to the appropriate cause of loss.
[3]
Excludes amounts reported in Commercial Lines and Personal Lines reporting segments (collectively “Ongoing Operations”) for asbestos and environmental net liabilities of $16 and $6, respectively, as of March 31, 2015. Total net losses and loss adjustment expenses incurred for the three months ended March 31, 2015 includes $2 related to asbestos and environmental claims. Total net losses and loss adjustment expenses paid for the three months ended March 31, 2015 includes $3 related to asbestos and environmental claims.
[4]
Gross of reinsurance, asbestos and environmental reserves, including liabilities in Ongoing Operations, were $2,147 and $255.
[5]
The one year and average three year net paid amounts for asbestos claims, including Ongoing Operations, are $203 and $198, respectively, resulting in a one year net survival ratio of 8.3 and a three year net survival ratio of 8.5. Net survival ratio is the quotient of the net carried reserves divided by the average annual payment amount and is an indication of the number of years that the net carried reserve would last (i.e. survive) if the future annual claim payments were consistent with the calculated historical average.
Three Months Ended March 31, 2014
Asbestos
 
Environmental
All Other
Total
Beginning liability—net [1][2]
$
1,714

  
$
270

$
990

$
2,974

Losses and loss adjustment expenses incurred

 

1

1

Less: losses and loss adjustment expenses paid
67

 
7

46

120

Ending liability – net [1][2]
$
1,647

[3] 
$
263

$
945

$
2,855

[1]
Excludes amounts reported in Ongoing Operations for asbestos and environmental net liabilities of $16 and $8, respectively, as of March 31, 2014. Total net losses and loss adjustment expenses incurred for the three months ended March 31, 2014 includes $4 related to asbestos and environmental claims. Total net losses and loss adjustment expenses paid for the three months ended March 31, 2014 includes $3 related to asbestos and environmental claims.
[2]
Gross of reinsurance, asbestos and environmental reserves, including liabilities in Ongoing Operations, were $2,107 and $306.
[3]
The one year and average three year net paid amounts for asbestos claims, including Ongoing Operations, are $216 and $195, respectively, resulting in a one year net survival ratio of 7.7 and a three year net survival ratio of 8.5. Net survival ratio is the quotient of the net carried reserves divided by the average annual payment amount and is an indication of the number of years that the net carried reserve would last (i.e. survive) if the future annual claim payments were consistent with the calculated historical average.
For paid and incurred losses and loss adjustment expenses reporting, the Company classifies its asbestos and environmental reserves into three categories: Direct, Assumed Reinsurance and London Market. Direct insurance includes primary and excess coverage. Assumed Reinsurance includes both “treaty” reinsurance (covering broad categories of claims or blocks of business) and “facultative” reinsurance (covering specific risks or individual policies of primary or excess insurance companies). London Market business includes the business written by one or more of the Company’s subsidiaries in the United Kingdom, which are no longer active in the insurance or reinsurance business. Such business includes both direct insurance and assumed reinsurance. Of the three categories of claims (Direct, Assumed Reinsurance and London Market), direct policies tend to have the greatest factual development from which to estimate the Company’s exposures.

73



Assumed Reinsurance exposures are less predictable than direct insurance exposures because the Company does not generally receive notice of a reinsurance claim until the underlying direct insurance claim is mature. This causes a delay in the receipt of information at the reinsurer level and adds to the uncertainty of estimating related reserves.
London Market exposures are the most uncertain of the three categories of claims. As a participant in the London Market (comprised of both Lloyd's of London and London Market companies), certain subsidiaries of the Company wrote business on a subscription basis, with those subsidiaries' involvement being limited to a relatively small percentage of a total contract placement. Claims are reported, via a broker, to the “lead” underwriter and, once agreed to, are presented to the following markets for concurrence. This reporting and claim agreement process makes estimating liabilities for this business the most uncertain of the three categories of claims.
The following table sets forth paid and incurred loss activity by the three categories of claims for asbestos and environmental.
Paid and Incurred Losses and Loss Adjustment Expenses (“LAE”) Development – Asbestos and Environmental
 
Asbestos [1]
Environmental [1]
Three Months Ended March 31, 2015
Paid
Losses &  LAE
Incurred
Losses &  LAE
Paid
Losses &  LAE
Incurred
Losses &  LAE
Gross
 
 
 
 
Direct
$
31

$

$
10

$
3

Assumed Reinsurance
9


1


London Market
5


5


Total
45


16

3

Ceded
(2
)



Net
$
43

$

$
16

$
3

[1]
Excludes asbestos and environmental paid and incurred loss and LAE reported in Ongoing Operations. Total gross losses and LAE incurred in Ongoing Operations for the three months ended March 31, 2015 includes $2 related to asbestos and environmental claims. Total gross losses and LAE paid in Ongoing Operations for the three months ended March 31, 2015 includes $3 related to asbestos and environmental claims.
Uncertainties Regarding Adequacy of Asbestos and Environmental Reserves
A number of factors affect the variability of estimates for asbestos and environmental reserves including assumptions with respect to the frequency of claims, the average severity of those claims settled with payment, the dismissal rate of claims with no payment and the expense to indemnity ratio. The uncertainty with respect to the underlying reserve assumptions for asbestos and environmental adds a greater degree of variability to these reserve estimates than reserve estimates for more traditional exposures. While this variability is reflected in part in the size of the range of reserves developed by the Company, that range may still not be indicative of the potential variance between the ultimate outcome and the recorded reserves. The recorded net reserves as of March 31, 2015 of $1.92 billion ($1.68 billion and $234 for asbestos and environmental, respectively) is within an estimated range, unadjusted for covariance, of $1.5 billion to $2.3 billion. The process of estimating asbestos and environmental reserves remains subject to a wide variety of uncertainties, which are detailed in the Company's 2014 Form 10-K Annual Report. The Company believes that its current asbestos and environmental reserves are appropriate. However, analyses of future developments could cause the Company to change its estimates and ranges of its asbestos and environmental reserves, and the effect of these changes could be material to the Company's consolidated operating results and liquidity.
Consistent with the Company's long-standing reserve practices, the Company will continue to review and monitor its reserves in Property & Casualty Other Operations regularly, including its annual reviews of asbestos liabilities, reinsurance recoverables and the allowance for uncollectible reinsurance, and environmental liabilities, and where future developments indicate, make appropriate adjustments to the reserves. The company will complete both its annual ground-up asbestos and environmental reserve studies during the second quarter of 2015. For a discussion of the Company's reserving practices, see MD&A - Critical Accounting Estimates, Property & Casualty Insurance Product Reserves, Net of Reinsurance in the Company's 2014 Form 10-K Annual Report.


74



Estimated Gross Profits Used in the Valuation and Amortization of Assets and Liabilities Associated with Variable Annuity and Other Universal Life-Type Contracts
Estimated gross profits are used in the amortization of the deferred policy acquisition costs ("DAC") asset; and sales inducement assets (“SIA”). Portions of EGPs are also used in the valuation of reserves for death and other insurance benefit features on variable annuity and other universal life type contracts.
The most significant EGP based balances are as follows:

 
Talcott Resolution
 
As of March 31, 2015
As of December 31, 2014
DAC
$
1,127

$
1,200

SIA
$
85

$
89

Death and Other Insurance Benefit Reserves, net of reinsurance [1]
$
323

$
331

[1]
For additional information on death and other insurance benefit reserves, see Note 6 - Separate Accounts, Death Benefits and Other Insurance Benefit Features of Notes to Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements.
Unlocks
The benefit to net income from continuing operations, net of tax by asset and liability as a result of the Unlocks is as follow:
 
Talcott Resolution
 
Three Months Ended March 31,
 
2015
2014
DAC
$
10

$
12

SIA
1

1

Death and Other Insurance Benefit Reserves
18

6

Total (before tax)
$
29

$
19

Income tax effect
10

7

Total (after-tax)
$
19

$
12

The Unlock benefit, after-tax, for the three months ended March 31, 2015 and March 31, 2014, was primarily due to separate account returns being above our aggregated estimated returns during the period.
An Unlock revises EGPs, on a quarterly basis, to reflect market updates of policyholder account value and the Company’s current best estimate assumptions. Modifications to the Company’s hedging programs may impact EGPs, and correspondingly impact DAC recoverability. After each quarterly Unlock, the Company also tests the aggregate recoverability of DAC by comparing the DAC balance to the present value of future EGPs. The margin between the DAC balance and the present value of future EGPs for U.S. individual variable annuities was 37% as of March 31, 2015. If the margin between the DAC asset and the present value of future EGPs is exhausted, then further reductions in EGPs would cause portions of DAC to be unrecoverable and the DAC asset would be written down to equal future EGPs.
In the third quarter of 2014, the Company completed a comprehensive non-market related policyholder behavior assumption study and incorporates the results of those studies into its projection of future gross profits. Beginning in 2015, the annual comprehensive non-market related policyholder behavior assumption study will be completed in the fourth quarter of the year.
KEY PERFORMANCE MEASURES AND RATIOS
The Company considers the measures and ratios in the following discussion to be key performance indicators for its businesses. Management believes that these ratios and measures are useful in understanding the underlying trends in The Hartford’s businesses. However, these key performance indicators should only be used in conjunction with, and not in lieu of, the results presented in the segment discussions that follow in this MD&A. These ratios and measures may not be comparable to other performance measures used by the Company’s competitors.

75



Definitions of Non-GAAP and other measures and ratios
Account Value
Account value includes policyholders’ balances for investment contracts and reserves for future policy benefits for insurance contracts. Account value is a measure used by the Company because a significant portion of the Company’s fee income is based upon the level of account value. These revenues increase or decrease with a rise or fall in the amount of account value whether caused by changes in the market or through net flows.
After-tax core earnings margin, excluding buyouts
After-tax core earnings margin, excluding buyouts, is a non-GAAP financial measure that the Company uses to evaluate, and believes is an important measure of, the Group Benefits segment’s operating performance. After-tax margin is the most directly comparable U.S. GAAP measure. The Company believes that after-tax core earnings margin, excluding buyouts, provides investors with a valuable measure of the performance of Group Benefits because it reveals trends in the business that may be obscured by the effect of buyouts. After-tax core earnings margin, excluding buyouts, should not be considered as a substitute for after-tax margin and does not reflect the overall profitability of Group Benefits. Therefore, the Company believes it is important for investors to evaluate both after-tax core earnings margin, excluding buyouts, and after-tax margin when reviewing performance. After-tax core earnings margin, excluding buyouts is calculated by dividing core earnings excluding buyouts by revenues excluding buyouts and realized gains (losses).
Assets Under Management
Assets under management (“AUM”) include account values and mutual fund assets. AUM is a measure used by the Company because a significant portion of the Company’s revenues are based upon asset values. These revenues increase or decrease with a rise or fall in the amount of account value whether caused by changes in the market or through net flows.
Catastrophe ratio
The catastrophe ratio (a component of the loss and loss adjustment expense ratio) represents the ratio of catastrophe losses incurred in the current calendar year (net of reinsurance) to earned premiums and includes catastrophe losses incurred for both the current and prior accident years. A catastrophe is an event that causes $25 or more in industry insured property losses and affects a significant number of property and casualty policyholders and insurers. The catastrophe ratio includes the effect of catastrophe losses, but does not include the effect of reinstatement premiums.
Combined ratio
The combined ratio is the sum of the loss and loss adjustment expense ratio, the expense ratio and the policyholder dividend ratio. This ratio is a relative measurement that describes the related cost of losses and expenses for every $100 of earned premiums. A combined ratio below 100 demonstrates underwriting profit; a combined ratio above 100 demonstrates underwriting losses.
Combined ratio before catastrophes and prior accident year development
The combined ratio before catastrophes and prior accident year development, a non-GAAP financial measure, represents the combined ratio for the current accident year, excluding the impact of catastrophes. Combined ratio is the most directly comparable U.S. GAAP measure.
Core Earnings
Core earnings, a non-GAAP measure, is an important measure of the Company’s operating performance. The Company believes that core earnings provides investors with a valuable measure of the performance of the Company’s ongoing businesses because it reveals trends in our insurance and financial services businesses that may be obscured by including the net effect of certain realized capital gains and losses, certain restructuring and other costs, pension settlements, loss on extinguishment of debt, reinsurance gains and losses from disposal of businesses, income tax benefit from reduction in deferred income tax valuation allowance, discontinued operations, and the impact of Unlocks to DAC, SIA, and death and other insurance benefit reserve balances. Some realized capital gains and losses are primarily driven by investment decisions and external economic developments, the nature and timing of which are unrelated to the insurance and underwriting aspects of our business. Accordingly, core earnings excludes the effect of all realized gains and losses (net of tax and the effects of DAC) that tend to be highly variable from period to period based on capital market conditions. The Company believes, however, that some realized capital gains and losses are integrally related to our insurance operations, so core earnings includes net realized gains and losses such as net periodic settlements on credit derivatives. These net realized gains and losses are directly related to an offsetting item included in the income statement such as net investment income. Net income (loss) is the most directly comparable U.S. GAAP measure. Core earnings should not be considered as a substitute for net income (loss) and does not reflect the overall profitability of the Company’s business. Therefore, the Company believes that it is useful for investors to evaluate both net income (loss) and core earnings when reviewing the Company’s performance.

76



A reconciliation of net income to core earnings is set forth in the following table:
 
Three Months Ended March 31,
 
2015
2014
Net income
$
467

$
495

Less: Unlock charge, after-tax
19

12

Less: Net realized capital gains (losses), after-tax and DAC, excluded from core earnings
2

(34
)
Less: Restructuring and other costs, after-tax
(6
)
(13
)
Less: Loss from discontinued operations, after-tax

29

Core earnings
$
452

$
501

Current accident year loss and loss adjustment expense ratio before catastrophes
The current accident year loss and loss adjustment expense ratio before catastrophes is a measure of the cost of non-catastrophe claims incurred in the current accident year divided by earned premiums. Management believes that the current accident year loss and loss adjustment expense ratio before catastrophes is a performance measure that is useful to investors as it removes the impact of volatile and unpredictable catastrophe losses and prior accident year reserve development.
Expense ratio
The expense ratio for the underwriting segments of Commercial Lines and Personal Lines is the ratio of underwriting expenses to earned premiums. Underwriting expenses include the amortization of deferred policy acquisition costs and insurance operating costs and expenses, including certain centralized services and bad debt expense. Deferred policy acquisition costs include commissions, taxes, licenses and fees and certain other underwriting expenses and are amortized over the policy term.
The expense ratio for Group Benefits is expressed as the ratio of insurance operating costs and other expenses and amortization of deferred policy acquisition costs, to premiums and other considerations, excluding buyout premiums.
Fee Income
Fee income is largely driven from amounts collected as a result of contractually defined percentages of assets under management. These fees are generally collected on a daily basis. Therefore, the growth in assets under management either through positive net flows or net sales, or favorable equity market performance will have a favorable impact on fee income. Conversely, either negative net flows or net sales, or unfavorable equity market performance will reduce fee income.
Full Surrender Rates
Full surrender rates are an internal measure of contract surrenders calculated using annualized full surrenders divided by a two-point average of annuity account values. The full surrender rate represents full contract liquidation and excludes partial withdrawals.
Loss and loss adjustment expense ratio
The loss and loss adjustment expense ratio is a measure of the cost of claims incurred in the calendar year divided by earned premium and includes losses incurred for both the current and prior accident years, as well as the costs of mortality and morbidity and other contractholder benefits to policyholders. Among other factors, the loss and loss adjustment expense ratio needed for the Company to achieve its targeted return on equity fluctuates from year to year based on changes in the expected investment yield over the claim settlement period, the timing of expected claim settlements and the targeted returns set by management based on the competitive environment.
The loss and loss adjustment expense ratio is affected by claim frequency and claim severity, particularly for shorter-tail property lines of business, where the emergence of claim frequency and severity is credible and likely indicative of ultimate losses. Claim frequency represents the percentage change in the average number of reported claims per unit of exposure in the current accident year compared to that of the previous accident year. Claim severity represents the percentage change in the estimated average cost per claim in the current accident year compared to that of the previous accident year. As one of the factors used to determine pricing, the Company’s practice is to first make an overall assumption about claim frequency and severity for a given line of business and then, as part of the ratemaking process, adjust the assumption as appropriate for the particular state, product or coverage.

77



Loss ratio, excluding buyouts
The loss ratio is utilized for the Group Benefits segment and is expressed as a ratio of benefits, losses and loss adjustment expenses to premiums and other considerations, excluding buyout premiums. Since Group Benefits occasionally buys a block of claims for a stated premium amount, the Company excludes this buyout from the loss ratio used for evaluating the underwriting results of the business as buyouts may distort the loss ratio. Buyout premiums represent takeover of open claim liabilities and other non-recurring premium amounts.
Mutual Fund Assets
Mutual fund assets are owned by the shareholders of those funds and not by the Company and therefore are not reflected in the Company’s consolidated financial statements. Mutual fund assets are a measure used by the Company because a significant portion of the Company’s revenues are based upon asset values. These revenues increase or decrease with a rise or fall in the amount of account value whether caused by changes in the market or through net flows.
New business written premium
New business written premium represents the amount of premiums charged for policies issued to customers who were not insured with the Company in the previous policy term. New business written premium plus renewal policy written premium equals total written premium.
Policies in force
Policies in force represent the number of policies with coverage in effect as of the end of the period. The number of policies in force is a growth measure used for Personal Lines and standard commercial lines within Commercial Lines and is affected by both new business growth and policy count retention.
Policy count retention
Policy count retention represents the ratio of the number of policies renewed during the period divided by the number of policies available to renew. The number of policies available to renew represents the number of policies, net of any cancellations, written in the previous policy term. Policy count retention is affected by a number of factors, including the percentage of renewal policy quotes accepted and decisions by the Company to non-renew policies because of specific policy underwriting concerns or because of a decision to reduce premium writings in certain classes of business or states. Policy count retention is also affected by advertising and rate actions taken by competitors.
Policyholder dividend ratio
The policyholder dividend ratio is the ratio of policyholder dividends to earned premium.
Prior accident year loss and loss adjustment expense ratio
The prior year loss and loss adjustment expense ratio represents the increase (decrease) in the estimated cost of settling catastrophe and non-catastrophe claims incurred in prior accident years as recorded in the current calendar year divided by earned premiums.
Reinstatement premiums
Reinstatement premium represents additional ceded premium paid for the reinstatement of the amount of reinsurance coverage that was reduced as a result of a reinsurance loss payment.
Renewal earned price increase (decrease)
Written premiums are earned over the policy term, which is six months for certain Personal Lines auto business and twelve months for substantially all of the remainder of the Company’s Property and Casualty business. Since the Company earns premiums over the six to twelve month term of the policies, renewal earned price increases (decreases) lag renewal written price increases (decreases) by six to twelve months.

78



Renewal written price increase (decrease)
Renewal written price increase (decrease) represents the combined effect of rate changes, amount of insurance and individual risk pricing decisions per unit of exposure since the prior year. The rate component represents the change in rate filings during the period and the amount of insurance represents the change in the value of the rating base, such as model year/vehicle symbol for auto, building replacement costs for property and wage inflation for workers’ compensation. A number of factors affect renewal written price increases (decreases) including expected loss costs as projected by the Company’s pricing actuaries, rate filings approved by state regulators, risk selection decisions made by the Company’s underwriters and marketplace competition. Renewal written price changes reflect the property and casualty insurance market cycle. Prices tend to increase for a particular line of business when insurance carriers have incurred significant losses in that line of business in the recent past or the industry as a whole commits less of its capital to writing exposures in that line of business. Prices tend to decrease when recent loss experience has been favorable or when competition among insurance carriers increases. Renewal written price statistics are subject to change from period to period, based on a number of factors, including changes in actuarial estimates and the effect of subsequent cancellations and non-renewals on rate achieved, and modifications made to better reflect ultimate pricing achieved.
Return on Assets (“ROA”), core earnings
ROA, core earnings, is a non-GAAP financial measure that the Company uses to evaluate, and believes is an important measure of, certain of the segment’s operating performance. ROA is the most directly comparable U.S. GAAP measure. The Company believes that ROA, core earnings, provides investors with a valuable measure of the performance of certain of the Company’s on-going businesses because it reveals trends in our businesses that may be obscured by the effect of realized gains (losses). ROA, core earnings, should not be considered as a substitute for ROA and does not reflect the overall profitability of our businesses. Therefore, the Company believes it is important for investors to evaluate both ROA, core earnings, and ROA when reviewing the Company’s performance. ROA is calculated by dividing core earnings by a two-point average AUM.
Underwriting gain (loss)
The Company's management evaluates profitability of the P&C businesses primarily on the basis of underwriting gain (loss). Underwriting gain (loss) is a before-tax measure that represents earned premiums less incurred losses, loss adjustment expenses and underwriting expenses. Underwriting gain (loss) is influenced significantly by earned premium growth and the adequacy of the Company's pricing. Underwriting profitability over time is also greatly influenced by the Company's pricing and underwriting discipline, which seeks to manage exposure to loss through favorable risk selection and diversification, its management of claims, its use of reinsurance and its ability to manage its expense ratio, which it accomplishes through economies of scale and its management of acquisition costs and other underwriting expenses. Net income (loss) is the most directly comparable GAAP measure. The Company believes that underwriting gain (loss) provides investors with a valuable measure of before-tax profitability derived from underwriting activities, which are managed separately from the Company's investing activities. A reconciliation of underwriting gain (loss) to net income (loss) for Commercial Lines, Personal Lines and Property & Casualty Other Operations is set forth in their respective discussions herein.
Written and earned premiums
Written premium is a statutory accounting financial measure which represents the amount of premiums charged for policies issued, net of reinsurance, during a fiscal period. Earned premium is a U.S. GAAP and statutory measure. Premiums are considered earned and are included in the financial results on a pro rata basis over the policy period. Management believes that written premium is a performance measure that is useful to investors as it reflects current trends in the Company’s sale of property and casualty insurance products. Written and earned premium are recorded net of ceded reinsurance premium.
Traditional life insurance type products, such as those sold by Group Benefits, collect premiums from policyholders in exchange for financial protection for the policyholder from a specified insurable loss, such as death or disability. These premiums together with net investment income earned from the overall investment strategy are used to pay the contractual obligations under these insurance contracts. Two major factors, new sales and persistency, impact premium growth. Sales can increase or decrease in a given year based on a number of factors, including but not limited to, customer demand for the Company’s product offerings, pricing competition, distribution channels and the Company’s reputation and ratings. Persistency refers to the percentage of policies remaining in-force from year-to-year.

79




COMMERCIAL LINES
 
Three Months Ended March 31,
Underwriting Summary
2015
2014
Change
Written premiums
$
1,722

$
1,669

3
%
Change in unearned premium reserve
139

128

9
%
Earned premiums
1,583

1,541

3
%
Losses and loss adjustment expenses
 
 
 
Current accident year before catastrophes
928

934

(1
%)
Current accident year catastrophes
58

60

(3
%)
Prior accident years
(2
)
(7
)
71
%
Total losses and loss adjustment expenses
984

987

%
Amortization of DAC
234

226

4
%
Underwriting expenses
295

217

36
%
Dividends to policyholders
5

4

25
%
Underwriting gain
65

107

(39
%)
Net servicing income [1]
4

3

33
%
Net investment income
257

256

%
Net realized capital gains (losses)
8

(32
)
125
%
Other income (expense)
1

(2
)
150
%
Income before income taxes
335

332

1
%
Income tax expense
95

90

6
%
Net income
$
240

$
242

(1
%)
[1]
Includes servicing revenues of $22 and $25 for the three months ended March 31, 2015 and 2014, respectively.
 
Three Months Ended March 31,
Premium Measures [1]
2015
2014
New business premium
$
290

$
268

Standard commercial lines policy count retention
84
%
83
%
Standard commercial lines renewal written pricing increases
3
%
6
%
Standard commercial lines renewal earned pricing increases
5
%
8
%
Standard commercial lines policies in-force as of end of period (in thousands)
1,283

1,252

[1]
Standard commercial lines consists of small commercial and middle market. Standard commercial premium measures exclude middle market specialty programs and livestock lines of business.
 
Three Months Ended March 31,
Underwriting Ratios
2015
2014
Change
Loss and loss adjustment expense ratio
 
 
 
Current accident year before catastrophes
58.6

60.6

2.0

Current accident year catastrophes
3.7

3.9

0.2

Prior year development
(0.1
)
(0.5
)
(0.4
)
Total loss and loss adjustment expense ratio
62.2

64.0

1.8

Expense ratio
33.4

28.7

(4.7
)
Policyholder dividend ratio
0.3

0.3


Combined ratio
95.9

93.1

(2.8
)
Current accident year catastrophes and prior year development
3.6

3.4

(0.2
)
Combined ratio before catastrophes and prior year development
92.4

89.6

(2.8
)

80



Three months ended March 31, 2015 compared to the three months ended March 31, 2014
Overview
Net income for the three months ended March 31, 2015, as compared to the prior year period, decreased slightly primarily due to a lower underwriting gain driven by higher underwriting expenses, largely offset by a shift to net realized capital gains in the current year period from net realized capital losses in the prior year period. Underwriting expenses for the three months ended March 31, 2014 included a reduction of $49, before tax, in the Company's estimated liability for NY Assessments.
Revenues - Earned and Written Premiums
Earned premiums for the three months ended March 31, 2015, as compared to the prior year period, increased reflecting written premium growth over the preceding twelve months.
Written premiums, as compared to the prior year period, increased for the three months ended March 31, 2015 in standard commercial lines, partially offset by a decrease in written premiums in specialty commercial. Written premium increases in standard commercial lines were driven primarily by new business premium growth and higher policy count retention, as well as renewal written pricing increases. For the three months ended March 31, 2015 written pricing increases averaged 3% in standard commercial, which includes 3% for small commercial and 2% for middle market, consistent with current loss costs trends. Written premium decreases in specialty commercial were primarily the result of lower renewal written premium in national accounts.
Losses and Loss Adjustment Expenses
Losses and loss adjustment expenses for the three months ended March 31, 2015, as compared to the prior year period, decreased reflecting lower current accident year losses before catastrophes in standard commercial lines, partially offset by lower favorable prior accident year development.
The reduction in the current accident year loss and loss adjustment expense ratios before catastrophes for the three months ended March 31, 2015, as compared to the prior year period, was primarily driven by a lower loss and loss adjustment expense ratio in workers' compensation due to earned pricing increases and favorable frequency and severity trends. Accordingly, the current accident year loss and loss adjustment expense ratio before catastrophes decreased by 2.0 points to 58.6 in the current quarter from 60.6 in the prior year quarter.
Current accident year catastrophe losses totaled $58, before tax, for the three months ended March 31, 2015, compared to $60, before tax, for the three months ended March 31, 2014. Catastrophe losses for both periods were primarily due to winter storms across various U.S. geographic regions. For additional information, see MD&A - Critical Accounting Estimates, Property & Casualty Insurance Product Reserves, Net of Reinsurance.
Prior accident years reserve release of $2, before tax, for the three months ended March 31, 2015, compared to a reserve release of $7, before tax, for the three months ended March 31, 2014. Net reserve releases for the three months ended March 31, 2015 were primarily due to a release of professional and general liability reserves, partially offset by reserve strengthening in commercial auto liability. Net reserve releases for the three months ended March 31, 2014 were primarily due to reserve releases related to 2013 catastrophes and professional liability, partially offset by workers' compensation discount accretion. For additional information, see MD&A - Critical Accounting Estimates, Reserve Roll-forwards and Development.
Underwriting Ratios
The combined ratio, before catastrophes and prior year development, increased 2.8 points from 89.6 for the three months ended March 31, 2014 to 92.4 for the three months ended March 31, 2015. The expense ratio for the three months ended March 31, 2014 includes a 3.2 point favorable impact related to a reduction in NY Assessments. Apart from the effect of the reduction in NY assessments in 2014, the current accident year loss and loss adjustment expense ratio before catastrophes decreased, partially offset by an increase in the expense ratio due to higher commissions.
Investment Results
Investment income increased for the three months ended March 31, 2015, as compared to the prior year period. For discussion of consolidated investment results, see MD&A - Investment Results, Net Investment Income (Loss) and Net Realized Capital Gains (Losses).
Income Taxes
The effective tax rates in 2015 and 2014 differ from the U.S. federal statutory rate of 35% primarily due to permanent differences related to investments in tax exempt securities. For discussion of income taxes, see Note 7 - Income Taxes of Notes to Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements.

81



PERSONAL LINES
 
Three Months Ended March 31,
Underwriting Summary
2015
2014
Change
Written premiums
$
939

$
927

1
%
Change in unearned premium reserve
(13
)
(1
)
NM

Earned premiums
952

928

3
%
Losses and loss adjustment expenses
 
 

Current accident year before catastrophes
618

590

5
%
Current accident year catastrophes
25

26

(4
%)
Prior accident years
(4
)
(34
)
88
%
Total losses and loss adjustment expenses
639

582

10
%
Amortization of DAC
90

85

6
%
Underwriting expenses
148

148

%
Underwriting gain
75

113

(34
%)
Net servicing income
1


NM

Net investment income
35

35

%
Net realized capital gains (losses)
1

(5
)
120
%
Other income (expenses)
(1
)
4

(125
%)
Income before income taxes
111

147

(24
)%
Income tax expense
35

48

(27
%)
Net income
$
76

$
99

(23
)%
 
Three Months Ended March 31,
Written Premiums
2015
2014
Change
Product Line
 
 
 
Automobile
$
671

$
660

2
%
Homeowners
268

267

%
Total
$
939

$
927

1
%
Earned Premiums
 
 

Product Line
 
 

Automobile
$
655

$
636

3
%
Homeowners
297

292

2
%
Total
$
952

$
928

3
%

82



 
Three Months Ended March 31,
Premium Measures
2015
2014
Policies in-force end of period (in thousands)
 
 
Automobile
2,053

2,033

Homeowners
1,305

1,324

New business written premium
 
 
Automobile
$
101

$
104

Homeowners
$
27

$
32

Policy count retention
 
 
Automobile
84
%
87
%
Homeowners
85
%
87
%
Renewal written pricing increase
 
 
Automobile
7
%
5
%
Homeowners
8
%
8
%
Renewal earned pricing increase
 
 
Automobile
6
%
5
%
Homeowners
8
%
7
%
 
Three Months Ended March 31,
Underwriting Ratios
2015
2014
Change
Loss and loss adjustment expense ratio
 
 
 
Current accident year before catastrophes
64.9

63.6

(1.3
)
Current accident year catastrophes
2.6

2.8

0.2

Prior year development
(0.4
)
(3.7
)
(3.3
)
Total loss and loss adjustment expense ratio
67.1

62.7

(4.4
)
Expense ratio
25.0

25.1

0.1

Combined ratio
92.1

87.8

(4.3
)
Current accident year catastrophes and prior year development
2.2

(0.9
)
(3.1
)
Combined ratio before catastrophes and prior year development
89.9

88.7

(1.2
)
 
Three Months Ended March 31,
Product Combined Ratios
2015
2014
Change
Automobile
95.4

92.6

(2.8
)
Homeowners
85.1

76.7

(8.4
)
Three months ended March 31, 2015 compared to the three months ended March 31, 2014
Overview
Net income for the three months ended March 31, 2015, as compared to the prior period, decreased primarily due to a lower underwriting gain driven by an increase in current accident year losses before catastrophes and lower favorable prior accident year development.
Revenues - Earned and Written Premiums
Earned and written premiums for the three months ended March 31, 2015, as compared to the prior year period, increased primarily due to renewal written and earned pricing increases. However, policy count retention was lower for the three months ended March 31, 2015, as compared to the prior year period, driven in part by renewal written pricing increases.

83



Losses and Loss Adjustment Expenses
Losses and loss adjustment expenses for the three months ended March 31, 2015, as compared to the prior year period, primarily reflect higher current accident year losses before catastrophes and lower favorable prior accident year development.
Current accident year losses and loss adjustment expenses before catastrophes increased for the three months ended March 31, 2015, compared to the prior year period, as a result of higher earned premiums, increased auto liability losses and increased auto physical damage severity. The current accident year loss and loss adjustment expense ratio before catastrophes of 64.9 in 2015 increased 1.3 points from 63.6 in 2014. The increase primarily reflects higher loss costs, higher auto liability losses and increased physical damage severity, partially offset by strong earned pricing.
Current accident year catastrophe losses of $25, before tax, for the three months ended March 31, 2015 compared to $26 for the prior year period. Catastrophe losses for both periods were primarily due to winter storms across various U.S. geographic regions.
Prior accident years reserve release of $4, before tax, for the three months ended March 31, 2015 compared to a release of $34, before tax, for the prior year period. Reserve releases for 2015 were primarily related to releases related to 2014 catastrophes offset by unfavorable development on accident year 2014 auto physical damage claims. Reserve releases for 2014 were primarily related to favorable development on accident year 2013 fire and water-related homeowners claims, and reserve releases related to fourth quarter 2013 catastrophes. For additional information, see MD&A - Critical Accounting Estimates, Property & Casualty Insurance Product Reserves, Net of Reinsurance.
Underwriting Ratios
The combined ratio, before current accident year catastrophes and prior year development, increased 1.2 points to 89.9 for the three months ended March 31, 2015. The increase primarily reflects an increase in the current accident year loss and loss adjustment expense ratio before catastrophes due to higher loss costs driven by large fire losses in property and increased physical damage severity, partially offset by strong earned pricing.
Investment Results
Investment income remained stable for the three months ended March 31, 2015, as compared to the prior year period. For discussion of consolidated investment results, see MD&A - Investment Results, Net Investment Income (Loss) and Net Realized Capital Gains (Losses).
Income Taxes
The effective tax rates in 2015 and 2014 differ from the U.S. federal statutory rate of 35% primarily due to permanent differences related to investments in tax exempt securities. For discussion of income taxes, see Note 7 - Income Taxes of Notes to Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements.

84



PROPERTY & CASUALTY OTHER OPERATIONS
 
Three Months Ended March 31,
Underwriting Summary
2015
2014
Change
Losses and loss adjustment expenses [1]
$
4

$
1

NM

Underwriting expenses
6

7

(14
%)
Underwriting loss
(10
)
(8
)
(25
%)
Net investment income
35

35

%
Net realized capital gains
4


NM

Other income
1


NM

Income before income taxes
30

27

11
%
Income tax expense
7

5

40
%
Net income
$
23

$
22

5
%
[1]
Consists of prior year loss reserve development.
Three months ended March 31, 2015 compared to the three months ended March 31, 2014
Net income was relatively flat for the three months ended March 31, 2015, as compared to the prior year period.
The annual reviews of asbestos and environmental liabilities occur in the second quarter of the year. For information on asbestos and environmental reserves, see Property & Casualty Other Operations Claims within the Property & Casualty Insurance Product Reserves, Net of Reinsurance section in Critical Accounting Estimates.
The effective tax rates in 2015 and 2014 differ from the U.S. federal statutory rate of 35% primarily due to permanent differences related to investments in tax exempt securities. For discussion of income taxes, see Note 7 - Income Taxes of Notes to Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements.

85



GROUP BENEFITS
 
Three months ended March 31,
Operating Summary
2015
2014
Change
Premiums and other considerations [1]
$
780

$
799

(2
)%
Net investment income
97

96

1
 %
Net realized capital gains (losses)
(1
)
8

(113
)%
Total revenues
876

903

(3
)%
Benefits, losses and loss adjustment expenses
598

597

 %
Amortization of deferred policy acquisition costs
8

9

(11
)%
Insurance operating costs and other expenses
200

228

(12
)%
Total benefits, losses and expenses
806

834

(3
)%
Income before income taxes
70

69

1
 %
Income tax expense
18

18

 %
Net income [1]
$
52

$
51

2
 %
[1]
Group Benefits has a block of Association - Financial Institutions business that is subject to a profit sharing arrangement with third parties which was terminated on December 31, 2014. The Association - Financial Institutions business represented $44 of premiums and other considerations and $1 of net income for the three months ended March 31, 2014.
 
Three months ended March 31,
Premiums and other considerations
2015
2014
Change
Fully insured – ongoing premiums
$
763

$
776

(2
)%
Buyout premiums

8

(100
)%
Other
17

15

13
 %
Total premiums and other considerations
$
780

$
799

(2
)%
Fully insured ongoing sales, excluding buyouts
$
300

$
180

67
 %
 
Three months ended March 31,
Ratios, excluding buyouts
2015
2014
Change
Group disability loss ratio
81.8
%
82.4
%
0.6
Group life loss ratio
73.2
%
67.9
%
(5.3)
Total loss ratio
76.7
%
74.5
%
(2.2)
Expense ratio
26.7
%
30.0
%
3.3
Selected ratios excluding Association - Financial Institutions
 
 
 
Group life loss ratio, excluding Association - Financial Institutions
73.2
%
74.0
%
0.8
Loss ratio, excluding Association - Financial Institutions
76.7
%
77.6
%
0.9
Expense ratio, excluding Association - Financial Institutions
26.7
%
27.4
%
0.7
 
Three months ended March 31,
After-tax margin
2015
2014
Change
After-tax margin (excluding buyouts)
5.9
%
5.7
%
0.2

Effect of net capital realized gains (losses), net of tax on after-tax margin
%
0.6
%
(0.6
)
After-tax core earnings margin (excluding buyouts)
5.9
%
5.1
%
0.8


86



Three months ended March 31, 2015 compared to the three months ended March 31, 2014
Net income increased slightly for the three months ended March 31, 2015, as compared to the prior year period, due to lower insurance operating costs and other expenses partially offset by lower premiums and other considerations and a change from net realized capital gains to net realized capital losses.
Premiums and other considerations for the three months ended March 31, 2015, decreased 2% compared to the prior year period, primarily due to management actions related to the Association - Financial Institutions block of business. Excluding the Association - Financial Institutions block of business, fully insured ongoing premiums increased 4% compared to the prior year period due to increased sales, improved book persistency and improved pricing. Insurance operating costs and other expenses decreased for the three months ended March 31, 2015, compared to the prior year period, primarily due to lower profit sharing expense related to the Association - Financial Institutions block of business.
Fully insured ongoing sales, excluding buyouts, increased by 67% for the three months ended March 31, 2015, as compared to the prior year period, due to an increase in large case accounts.
The total loss ratio increased 2.2 points to 76.7% for the three months ended March 31, 2015, as compared to the prior year period due to the impact of the Association - Financial Institutions block of business. Excluding the Association - Financial Institutions block of business, the loss ratio improved 0.9 points to 76.7%, as compared to the prior year period, due to favorable life and accidental death and dismemberment ("AD&D") experience and favorable disability results driven by improved incidence, pricing and continued strong long-term disability claim recoveries.
The expense ratio improved 3.3 points to 26.7% for the three months ended March 31, 2015, as compared to the prior year period, primarily due to lower profit sharing expense related to the Association - Financial Institutions block of business in relation to lower premium and other considerations.
The after-tax core earnings margin, excluding buyouts, improved 0.8 points to 5.9% for the three months ended March 31, 2015, as compared to the prior year period. The improvement was primarily due to the improved loss ratio excluding the Association - Financial Institutions block of business.
Investment income increased slightly for the three months ended March 31, 2015, as compared to the prior year period. For discussion of consolidated investment results, see MD&A - Investment Results, Investment Income (Loss) and Net Realized Capital Gains (Losses).
The effective tax rates in 2015 and 2014 differ from the U.S. federal statutory rate of 35% primarily due to permanent differences related to investments in tax exempt securities. For discussion of income taxes, see Note 7 - Income Taxes of Notes to Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements.

87



MUTUAL FUNDS
 
Three Months Ended March 31,
Operating Summary
2015
2014
Change
Fee income and other
$
179

$
174

3
 %
Total revenues
179

174

3
 %
Amortization of DAC
5

9

(44
)%
Insurance operating costs and other expenses
140

132

6
 %
Total benefits, losses and expenses
145

141

3
 %
Income before income taxes
34

33

3
 %
Income tax expense
12

12

 %
Net income
$
22

$
21

5
 %
 
 
 
 
Average Total Mutual Funds segment AUM
94,778

97,519

(3
)%
ROA, core earnings
$
9.3

$
8.6

8
 %
 
 
 
 
Mutual Funds segment AUM
 
 
 
 Mutual Fund AUM - beginning of period
$
73,035

$
70,918

3
 %
Sales
4,710

3,692

28
 %
Redemptions
(4,181
)
(3,674
)
(14
)%
Net Flows
529

18

NM

Change in market value and other
2,132

2,410

(12
)%
 Mutual Fund AUM - end of period
$
75,696

$
73,346

3
 %
Talcott AUM [1]
$
20,240

$
24,957

(19
)%
Total Mutual Funds segment AUM
$
95,936

$
98,303

(2
)%
 
 
 
 
Mutual Fund AUM by Asset Class
 
 
 
Equity
$
47,131

$
44,489

6
 %
Fixed Income
14,267

14,661

(3
)%
Multi-Strategy Investments [2]
14,298

14,196

1
 %
Mutual Fund AUM
$
75,696

$
73,346

3
 %
[1]
Talcott AUM consist of Company-sponsored mutual fund assets held in separate accounts supporting variable insurance and investment products.
[2]
Includes balanced, allocation, and alternative investment products.
Three months ended March 31, 2015 compared to the three months ended March 31, 2014
Net income for the three months ended March 31, 2015, compared to the prior year period, increased due to higher revenue partially offset by increased operating costs. The increase in revenue is the result of growth in Mutual Fund AUM offset by the continued runoff of Talcott AUM.
The Mutual Funds segment average AUM decreased to $94.8 billion at March 31, 2015 from $97.5 billion at March 31, 2014 primarily resulting from a transfer to the HIMCO Variable Insurance Trust ("HVIT") assets within The Hartford of $2.7 billion in the fourth quarter of 2014. Mutual Fund AUM increased to $75.7 billion at March 31, 2015 from $73.3 billion at March 31, 2014 resulting from higher market performance and higher sales.

88



TALCOTT RESOLUTION

 
Three Months Ended March 31,
Operating Summary
2015
2014
Change
Earned premiums, fees and other
$
285

$
353

(19
%)
Net investment income
382

400

(5
%)
Realized capital gains (losses):
 
 


Total other-than-temporary impairment (“OTTI”) losses
(5
)
(4
)
(25
%)
Other net realized capital gains (losses)
(20
)
7

NM

Net realized capital gains (losses)
(25
)
3

NM

Total revenues
642

756

(15
%)
Benefits, losses and loss adjustment expenses
338

409

(17
%)
Amortization of DAC
50

67

(25
%)
Insurance operating costs and other expenses
121

148

(18
%)
Total benefits, losses and expenses
509

624

(18
%)
Income from continuing operations before income taxes
133

132

1
%
Income tax expense
22

16

38
%
Income from continuing operations, net of tax
111

116

(4
%)
Income from discontinued operations, net of tax [1]

29

(100
%)
Net income
$
111

$
145

(23
%)
Assets Under Management (end of period)
 
 

Variable annuity account value
$
51,500

$
77,347

(33
%)
Fixed Market Value Adjusted annuity and other account value
8,666

13,046

(34
%)
Institutional annuity account value
15,663

16,951

(8
%)
Other account value [2]
107,543

107,918

%
Total account value [3]
$
183,372

$
214,240

(14
%)
Variable Annuity Account Value [4]
 
 

Account value, beginning of period
$
52,861

$
61,812

(14
%)
Net outflows
(2,296
)
(2,950
)
22
%
Change in market value and other
935

685

36
%
Account value, end of period
$
51,500

$
59,547

(14
%)
[1]
Represents the income from operations of HLIKK. For additional information, see Note 12 - Discontinued Operations of Notes to Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements.
[2]
Other account value includes $52.6 billion, $15.0 billion, and $40.0 billion as of March 31, 2015 for the Retirement Plans, Individual Life and Private Placement Life Insurance, respectively. Other account value includes $54.3 billion, $14.7 billion, $39.0 billion at March 31, 2014 for the Retirement Plans, Individual Life, Private Placement Life Insurance businesses, respectively. Account values associated with the Retirement Plans and Individual Life businesses no longer generate asset-based fee income due to the sales of these businesses through reinsurance transactions.
[3]
Included in the total account value is approximately $(1.0) billion as of March 31, 2014 related to a Talcott Resolution intra-segment funding agreement which is eliminated in consolidation. Also included in the variable and fixed annuity account values as of March 31, 2014 is account value related to the Japan businesses sold on June 30, 2014.
[4]
Excludes account value related to the Japan business sold on June 30, 2014.

89



Three months ended March 31, 2015 compared to the three months ended March 31, 2014
Net income for the three months ended March 31, 2015, as compared to the prior year period, decreased primarily due to lower fee income due to the continued runoff of the variable annuity block, decrease in income from discontinued operations due to the sale of HLIKK, and increased realized capital losses, partially offset by lower insurance operating costs and other expenses, and lower amortization of DAC.
Account values for Talcott Resolution decreased to approximately $183 billion at March 31, 2015 from approximately $214 billion at March 31, 2014 primarily due to the sale of HLIKK and net outflows partially offset by market value appreciation in variable annuities. For the three months ended March 31, 2015, variable annuity net outflows were approximately 2.3 billion due to the continued runoff of the business and in-force management initiatives.
For the three months ended March 31, 2015, the annualized full surrender rate on variable annuities declined to 10.9% compared to 12.3% for the three months ended March 31, 2014. This decline was primarily due to a lower impact from in-force management initiatives and lower surrender activity.
Contract counts decreased 13% for variable annuities at March 31, 2015 compared to March 31, 2014 primarily due to in-force management initiatives and the continued aging and runoff of the block.  
The effective tax rates in 2014 and 2013 differ from the U.S. federal statutory rate of 35% primarily due to permanent differences related to investments in separate account DRD. For discussion of income taxes, see Note 7 - Income Taxes of Notes to Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements.

90



CORPORATE
 
Three Months Ended March 31,
Operating Summary
2015
2014
Change
Fee income [1]
$
2

$
3

(33
%)
Net investment income
3

2

50
%
Net realized capital gains (losses)
18

(9
)
NM

Total revenues
23

(4
)
NM

Insurance operating costs and other expenses [1]
17

32

(47
%)
Interest expense
94

95

(1
%)
Total benefits, losses and expenses
111

127

(13
%)
Loss from continuing operations before income taxes
(88
)
(131
)
33
%
Income tax benefit
(31
)
(46
)
33
%
Net loss
$
(57
)
$
(85
)
33
%
[1]
Fee income includes the income associated with the sales of non-proprietary insurance products in the Company’s broker-dealer subsidiaries that has an offsetting commission expense included in insurance operating costs and other expenses.
Three months ended March 31, 2015 compared to the three months ended March 31, 2014
Net loss decreased for the three months ended March 31, 2015 compared to the prior year period primarily due to an increase in realized capital gains, and decreases in insurance operating costs and other expenses, which were driven by a reduction in restructuring costs. For discussion of investment results, see MD&A - Investment Results, Net Investment Income (loss) and Net Realized Capital Gains (losses).
For a reconciliation of the consolidated tax provision at the U.S. federal statutory rate of 35% to the provision (benefit) for income taxes, see Note 7 - Income Taxes of Notes to Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements.

91



ENTERPRISE RISK MANAGEMENT
The Company has an enterprise risk management function (“ERM”) that is charged with providing analysis of the Company’s risks on an individual and aggregated basis and with ensuring that the Company’s risks remain within its risk appetite and tolerances. The Company has established the Enterprise Risk and Capital Committee (“ERCC”) that includes the Company’s CEO, President of the Company, Chief Financial Officer (“CFO”), Chief Investment Officer (“CIO”), Chief Risk Officer, General Counsel and others as deemed necessary by the committee chair. The ERCC is responsible for managing the Company’s risks and overseeing the enterprise risk management program.
The Company categorizes its main risks as follows:
Insurance Risk
Operational Risk
Financial Risk
Refer to the MD&A in The Hartford’s 2014 Form 10-K Annual Report for an explanation of the Company’s Operational Risk.
Insurance Risk Management
The Company categorizes its insurance risks across both property-casualty and life products. The Company establishes risk limits to control potential loss and actively monitors the risk exposures as a percent of statutory surplus. The Company also uses reinsurance to transfer insurance risk to well-established and financially secure reinsurers.
Reinsurance as a Risk Management Strategy
The Company utilizes reinsurance to transfer risk to affiliated and unaffiliated insurers. Reinsurance is used to manage aggregation of risk as well as to transfer certain risk to reinsurance companies based on specific geographic or risk concentrations. Such arrangements do not relieve the Company of its primary liability to policyholders. Failure of reinsurers to honor their obligations could result in losses to the Company.
The Company is a member of and participates in several reinsurance pools and associations. The Company evaluates the financial condition of its reinsurers and concentrations of credit risk. Reinsurance is placed with reinsurers that meet strict financial criteria established by the Company.
Reinsurance for Catastrophes
The Company has several catastrophe reinsurance programs, including reinsurance treaties that cover property and workers' compensation losses aggregating from single catastrophe events. The following table summarizes the primary catastrophe treaty reinsurance coverages that the Company has in place as of March 31, 2015:
Coverage
Treaty term
% of layer(s) reinsurance
Per occurrence limit
 
Retention
Principal property catastrophe program covering property catastrophe losses from a single event [1]
1/1/2015 to 1/1/2016
90%
$
850

 
$
350

Reinsurance with the FHCF covering Florida Personal Lines property catastrophe losses from a single event
6/1/2014 to 6/1/2015
90%
$
109

[2]
$
41

Workers compensation losses arising from a single catastrophe event [3]
7/1/2014 to 7/1/2015
80%
$
350

 
$
100

[1]
Certain aspects of our catastrophe treaty have terms that extend beyond the traditional one year term.
[2]
The per occurrence limit on the FHCF treaty is $109 for the 6/1/2014 to 6/1/2015 treaty year based on the Company's election to purchase the required coverage from FHCF. Coverage is based on the best available information from FHCF, which was updated in January 2015.
[3]
In addition, to the preceding limit shown, the workers compensation reinsurance includes a non-catastrophe, industrial accident layer, 80% of a $30 per event limit in excess a $20 retention.
In addition to the property catastrophe reinsurance coverage described in the above table, the Company has other catastrophe and working layer treaties and facultative reinsurance agreements that cover property catastrophe losses on an aggregate excess of loss and on a per risk basis. The principal property catastrophe reinsurance program and certain other reinsurance programs include a provision to reinstate limits in the event that a catastrophe loss exhausts limits on one or more layers under the treaties. In addition, covering the period from January 1, 2014 to December 31, 2016, the Company has an aggregate loss treaty in place which provides one limit of $200 over the three-year period of aggregate qualifying property catastrophe losses in excess of a net retention of $860.

92



In addition to the reinsurance protection provided by The Hartford's traditional property catastrophe reinsurance program described above, until February 18, 2015, the Hartford had a fully collateralized reinsurance coverage from Foundation Re III for losses sustained from qualifying hurricane loss events. Under the terms of the treaty, the Company had coverage for losses from hurricanes using a customized industry index contract designed to replicate The Hartford's own catastrophe losses, with a provision that the actual losses incurred by the Company for covered events, net of reinsurance recoveries, cannot be less than zero.
Reinsurance Recoverables
Reinsurance Security
To manage reinsurer credit risk, a reinsurance security review committee evaluates the credit standing, financial performance, management and operational quality of each potential reinsurer. Through this process, the Company maintains a centralized list of reinsurers approved for participation in reinsurance transactions. Only reinsurers approved through this process are eligible to participate in new reinsurance transactions. The Company's approval designations reflect the differing credit exposure associated with various classes of business. Participation eligibility is categorized based upon the nature of the risk reinsured, including the expected liability payout duration. In addition to defining participation eligibility, the Company regularly monitors credit risk exposure to each reinsurance counterparty and has established limits tiered by counterparty credit rating. For further discussion on how the Company manages and mitigates third party credit risk, see MD&A - Enterprise Risk Management, Credit Risk.
Property & Casualty Insurance Product Reinsurance Recoverables
Property & Casualty insurance product reinsurance recoverables represent loss and loss adjustment expense recoverables from a number of entities, including reinsurers and pools.
The components of the gross and net reinsurance recoverables are summarized as follows:
Reinsurance Recoverables
As of March 31, 2015
As of December 31, 2014
Paid loss and loss adjustment expenses
$
131

$
133

Unpaid loss and loss adjustment expenses
2,824

2,868

Gross reinsurance recoverables
$
2,955

$
3,001

Less: Allowance for uncollectible reinsurance
(273
)
(271
)
Net reinsurance recoverables
$
2,682

$
2,730

Life Insurance Product Reinsurance Recoverables
Life insurance product reinsurance recoverables represent future policy benefits and unpaid loss and loss adjustment expenses and other policyholder funds and benefits payable that are recoverable from a number of reinsurers.
The components of the gross and net reinsurance recoverables are as follows:
Reinsurance Recoverables
As of March 31, 2015
As of December 31, 2014
Future policy benefits and unpaid loss and loss adjustment expenses and other policyholder funds and benefits payable
20,055

20,190

Gross reinsurance recoverables
$
20,055

$
20,190

Less: Allowance for uncollectible reinsurance [1]


Net reinsurance recoverables
$
20,055

$
20,190

[1] No allowance for uncollectible reinsurance is required as of March 31, 2015 and December 31, 2014.
As of March 31, 2015, the Company has reinsurance recoverables from MassMutual and Prudential of $8.4 billion and $10.4 billion, respectively. As of December 31, 2014, the Company has reinsurance recoverables from MassMutual and Prudential of $8.6 billion and $10.4 billion, respectively. These reinsurance recoverables are secured by invested assets held in trust for the benefit of the Company in the event of a default by the reinsurers. As of March 31, 2015, the fair value of assets held in trust securing the Company's reinsurance recoverables from MassMutual and Prudential were $8.7 billion and $9.4 billion, respectively. Net of invested assets held in trust, as of March 31, 2015, the Company has no reinsurance-related concentrations of credit risk greater than 10% of the Company’s consolidated stockholders’ equity.
For further explanation of the Company's Insurance Risk Management strategy, see MD&A - Enterprise Risk Management - Insurance Risk Management in The Hartford's 2014 Form 10-K Annual Report.

93



Financial Risk Management
The Company identifies the following categories of financial risk:
Liquidity Risk
Interest Rate Risk
Foreign Currency Exchange Risk
Equity Risk
Credit Risk
Financial risks include direct, and indirect risks to the Company’s financial objectives coming from events that impact market conditions or prices. Financial risk also includes exposure to events that may cause correlated movement in multiple risk factors. The primary source of financial risks are the Company’s general account assets and the liabilities that those assets back, together with the guarantees which the company has written over various liability products, particularly its portfolio of variable annuities. The Company assesses its financial risk on a U.S. GAAP, statutory and economic basis. The Hartford has developed a disciplined approach to financial risk management that is well integrated into the Company’s underwriting, pricing, hedging, claims, asset and liability management, new product, and capital management processes. Consistent with its risk appetite, the Company establishes financial risk limits to control potential loss. Exposures are actively monitored, and mitigated where appropriate. The Company uses various risk management strategies, including reinsurance and over-the-counter and exchange traded derivatives with counterparties meeting the appropriate regulatory and due diligence requirements.
Liquidity Risk
Liquidity risk is the risk to current or prospective earnings or capital arising from the Company’s inability or perceived inability to meet its contractual cash obligations at the legal entity level when they come due over given time horizons without incurring unacceptable costs and without relying on uncommitted funding sources. Liquidity risk includes the inability to manage unplanned increases or accelerations in cash outflows, decreases or changes in funding sources, and changes in market conditions that affect the ability to liquidate assets quickly to meet obligations with minimal loss in value. Components of liquidity risk include funding risk, company specific liquidity risk and market liquidity risk. Funding risk is the gap between sources and uses of cash under normal and stressed conditions taking into consideration structural, regulatory and legal entity constraints. Changes in institution-specific conditions that affect the Company’s ability to sell assets or otherwise transact business without incurring a significant loss in value is company specific liquidity risk. Changes in general market conditions that affect the institution’s ability to sell assets or otherwise transact business without incurring a significant loss in value is market liquidity risk.
The Company has defined ongoing monitoring and reporting requirements to assess liquidity across the enterprise. The Company measures and manages liquidity risk exposures and funding needs within prescribed limits and across legal entities, business lines and currencies, taking into account legal, regulatory and operational limitations to the transferability of liquidity. The Company also monitors internal and external conditions, identifies material risk changes and emerging risks that may impact liquidity. The Company’s CFO has primary responsibility for liquidity risk.
For further discussion on liquidity see the section on Capital Resources and Liquidity.
Interest Rate Risk
Interest rate risk is the risk of financial loss due to adverse changes in the value of assets and liabilities arising from movements in interest rates. Interest rate risk encompasses exposures with respect to changes in the level of interest rates, the shape of the term structure of rates and the volatility of interest rates. Interest rate risk does not include exposure to changes in credit spreads. The Company has exposure to interest rates arising from its fixed maturity securities, interest sensitive liabilities and discount rate assumptions associated with the Company’s pension and other post retirement benefit obligations.
An increase in interest rates from current levels is generally a favorable development for the Company. Interest rate increases are expected to provide additional net investment income, reduce the cost of the variable annuity hedging program, limit the potential risk of margin erosion due to minimum guaranteed crediting rates in certain Talcott Resolution products. Conversely, if long-term interest rates rise dramatically within a six to twelve month time period, certain Talcott Resolution businesses may be exposed to disintermediation risk. Disintermediation risk refers to the risk that policyholders will surrender their contracts in a rising interest rate environment requiring the Company to liquidate assets in an unrealized loss position. In conjunction with the interest rate risk measurement and management techniques, certain of Talcott Resolution's fixed income product offerings have market value adjustment provisions at contract surrender. An increase in interest rates may also impact the Company’s tax planning strategies and in particular its ability to utilize tax benefits of previously recognized realized capital losses.

94



A decline in interest rates results in certain mortgage-backed and municipal securities being more susceptible to paydowns and prepayments or calls. During such periods, the Company generally will not be able to reinvest the proceeds at comparable yields. Lower interest rates will also likely result in lower net investment income, increased hedging cost associated with variable annuities and, if declines are sustained for a long period of time, it may subject the Company to reinvestment risk, higher pension costs expense and possibly reduced profit margins associated with guaranteed crediting rates on certain Talcott Resolution products. Conversely, the fair value of the investment portfolio will increase when interest rates decline and the Company’s interest expense will be lower on its variable rate debt obligations.
The Company manages its exposure to interest rate risk by constructing investment portfolios that maintain asset allocation limits and asset/liability duration matching targets which may include the use of derivatives. The Company analyzes interest rate risk using various models including parametric models and cash flow simulation under various market scenarios of the liabilities and their supporting investment portfolios, which may include derivative instruments. Key metrics that the Company uses to quantify its exposure to interest rate risk inherent in its invested assets and interest rate sensitive liabilities include duration, convexity and key rate duration. Duration is the price sensitivity of a financial instrument or series of cash flows to a parallel change in the underlying yield curve used to value the financial instrument or series of cash flows. For example, a duration of 5 means the price of the security will change by approximately 5% for a 100 basis point change in interest rates. Convexity is used to approximate how the duration of a security changes as interest rates change in a parallel manner. Key rate duration analysis measures the price sensitivity of a security or series of cash flows to each point along the yield curve and enables the Company to estimate the price change of a security assuming non-parallel interest rate movements.
To calculate duration, convexity, and key rate durations, projections of asset and liability cash flows are discounted to a present value using interest rate assumptions. These cash flows are then revalued at alternative interest rate levels to determine the percentage change in fair value due to an incremental change in the entire yield curve for duration and convexity, or a particular point on the yield curve for key rate duration. Cash flows from corporate obligations are assumed to be consistent with the contractual payment streams on a yield to worst basis. Yield to worst is a basis that represents the lowest potential yield that can be received without the issuer actually defaulting. The primary assumptions used in calculating cash flow projections include expected asset payment streams taking into account prepayment speeds, issuer call options and contract holder behavior. Mortgage-backed and asset-backed securities are modeled based on estimates of the rate of future prepayments of principal over the remaining life of the securities. These estimates are developed by incorporating collateral surveillance and anticipated future market dynamics. Actual prepayment experience may vary from these estimates.
The Company is also exposed to interest rate risk based upon the discount rate assumption associated with the Company’s pension and other postretirement benefit obligations. The discount rate assumption is based upon an interest rate yield curve comprised of bonds rated AA with maturities primarily between zero and thirty years. For further discussion of discounting pension and other postretirement benefit obligations, see the Critical Accounting Estimates Section of the MD&A under Pension and Other Postretirement Benefit Obligations and Note 17- Employee Benefit Plans of Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements in The Hartford’s 2014 Form 10-K Annual Report. In addition, management evaluates performance of certain Talcott Resolution products based on net investment spread which is, in part, influenced by changes in interest rates. For further discussion, see the Talcott Resolution section of the MD&A.
Foreign Currency Exchange Risk
Foreign currency exchange risk is defined as the risk of financial loss due to changes in the relative value between currencies. The Company’s foreign currency exchange risk is related to non-U.S. dollar denominated investments, which primarily consist of fixed maturity investments, and a yen denominated fixed payout annuity that is reinsured from HLIKK, a former indirect wholly-owned subsidiary that was sold in 2014. In addition, the Company’s Talcott Resolution operations issued non-U.S. dollar denominated funding agreement liability contracts. A significant portion of the Company’s foreign currency exposure is mitigated through the use of derivatives.
Fixed Maturity Investments
The risk associated with the non-U.S. dollar denominated fixed maturities relates to potential decreases in value and income resulting from unfavorable changes in foreign exchange rates. In order to manage currency exposures, the Company enters into foreign currency swaps to hedge the variability in cash flows as the fair value associated with certain foreign denominated fixed maturities decline. These foreign currency swaps are structured to match the foreign currency cash flows of the hedged foreign denominated securities.
Liabilities
The Company has foreign currency exchange risk associated with the yen denominated Japan fixed payout annuities reinsured from HLIKK. The Company has entered into pay U.S. dollar, receive yen swap contracts to hedge the currency exposure between the U.S. dollar denominated assets and the yen denominated fixed liability reinsurance payments.
The Company’s Talcott Resolution operations issued non-U.S. dollar denominated funding agreement liability contracts. The Company hedges the foreign currency risk associated with these liability contracts with currency rate swaps.

95


Equity Risk
Equity risk is defined as the risk of financial loss due to changes in the value of global equities or equity indices. The Company has exposure to equity risk from assets under management, embedded derivatives within the Company’s variable annuities and assets that support the Company’s pension plans. Equity Risk on the Company’s variable annuity products is mitigated through various hedging programs. (See the Variable Annuity Hedging Program Section)
The Company's exposure to equity risk includes the potential for lower earnings associated with certain businesses such as mutual funds and variable annuities where fee income is earned based upon the value of the assets under management. For further discussion of equity risk, see the following Variable Product Guarantee Risks and Risk Management section. In addition, Talcott Resolution includes certain guaranteed benefits, primarily associated with variable annuity products, which increase the Company's potential benefit exposure in the periods that equity markets decline.
The Company is also subject to equity risk based upon the assets that support its pension plans. The asset allocation mix is reviewed on a periodic basis. In order to minimize risk, the pension plans maintain a listing of permissible and prohibited investments. In addition, the pension plans have certain concentration limits and investment quality requirements imposed on permissible investment options.
Variable Product Guarantee Risks and Risk Management
The Company’s variable products are significantly influenced by the U.S. and other equity markets. Increases or declines in equity markets impact certain assets and liabilities related to the Company’s variable products and the Company’s earnings derived from those products. The Company’s variable products include U.S. variable annuity contracts and mutual funds.
Generally, declines in equity markets will:
reduce the value of assets under management and the amount of fee income generated from those assets;
increase the liability for GMWB benefits resulting in realized capital losses;
increase the value of derivative assets used to hedge product guarantees resulting in realized capital gains;
increase the costs of the hedging instruments we use in our hedging program;
increase the Company’s net amount at risk ("NAR") for GMDB and GMWB benefits;
increase the amount of required assets to be held backing variable annuity guarantees to maintain required regulatory reserve levels and targeted risk based capital ratios; and
decrease the Company’s estimated future gross profits, resulting in a DAC unlock charge. See Estimated Gross Profits Used in the Valuation and Amortization of Assets and Liabilities Associated with Variable Annuity Contracts within the Critical Accounting Estimates section of the MD&A for further information.
Generally, increases in equity markets will reduce the value of the hedge derivative assets, resulting in realized capital losses, and will generally have the inverse impact of those listed in the preceding discussion. For additional information, see Risk Hedging - Variable Annuity Hedging Program section.
Variable Annuity Guaranteed Benefits
The Company’s variable annuities include GMDB and certain contracts include GMWB features. Declines in the equity markets will increase the Company’s liability for these benefits. Most contracts with a GMDB include a maximum anniversary value ("MAV"), which in rising markets resets the guarantee on anniversary to be ‘at the money’. As the MAV increases, it can increase the NAR for subsequent declines in account value. Generally, a GMWB contract is ‘in the money’ if the contract holder’s guaranteed remaining balance (“GRB”) becomes greater than the account value.
The NAR is generally defined as the guaranteed minimum benefit amount in excess of the contract holder’s current account value. Variable annuity account values with guarantee features were $51.5 billion and $52.9 billion as of March 31, 2015 and December 31, 2014, respectively.

96


The following table summarizes the account values of the Company’s variable annuities with guarantee features and the NAR split between various guarantee features (retained net amount at risk does not take into consideration the effects of the variable annuity hedge programs in place as of each balance sheet date):
Total Variable Annuity Guarantees
As of March 31, 2015
($ in billions)
Account
Value
Gross Net
Amount at Risk
Retained Net
Amount at Risk
% of Contracts In
the Money [2]
% In the
Money [2] [3]
Variable Annuity [1]
 
 
 
 
 
GMDB
51.5

3.7

0.7

20
%
16
%
GMWB
24.0

0.2

0.1

6
%
12
%
Total Variable Annuity Guarantees
As of December 31, 2014
($ in billions)
Account
Value
Gross Net
Amount at Risk
Retained Net
Amount at Risk
% of Contracts In
the Money [2]
% In the
Money [2] [3]
Variable Annuity [1]
 
 
 
 
 
GMDB
$
52.9

$
3.8

$
0.8

23
%
14
%
GMWB
24.8

0.2

0.1

6
%
11
%
[1]
Policies with a guaranteed living benefit also have a guaranteed death benefit. The NAR for each benefit is shown; however these benefits are not additive. When a policy terminates due to death, any NAR related to GMWB is released. Similarly, when a policy goes into benefit status on a GMWB, the GMDB NAR is reduced to zero.
[2]
Excludes contracts that are fully reinsured.
[3]
For all contracts that are “in the money”, this represents the percentage by which the average contract was in the money.
Many policyholders with a GMDB also have a GMWB. Policyholders that have a product that offers both guarantees can only receive the GMDB or GMWB. The GMDB NAR disclosed in the preceding tables is a point in time measurement and assumes that all participants utilize the GMDB benefit on that measurement date. For additional information on the Company’s GMDB liability, see Note 6 - Separate Accounts, Death Benefits and Other Insurance Benefit Features of Notes to Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements.
The Company expects to incur GMDB payments in the future only if the policyholder has an “in the money” GMDB at their death. For policies with a GMWB rider, if the account value is reduced to a specified level, the contract holder will receive an annuity equal to the GRB. For the Company’s “life-time” GMWB products, this annuity can exceed the GRB. As the account value fluctuates with equity market returns on a daily basis and the “life-time” GMWB payments may exceed the GRB, the ultimate amount to be paid by the Company, if any, is uncertain and could be significantly more or less than the Company’s current carried liability. For additional information on the Company’s GMWB liability, see Note 4 - Fair Value Measurements of Notes to Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements.
Variable Annuity Market Risk Exposures
The following table summarizes the broad Variable Annuity Guarantees offered by the Company and the market risks to which the guarantee is most exposed from a U.S. GAAP accounting perspective:
Variable Annuity Guarantees [1]
U.S. GAAP Treatment [1]
Primary Market Risk Exposures [1]
GMDB and life-contingent component of the GMWB
Accumulation of the portion of fees required to cover expected claims, less accumulation of actual claims paid
Equity Market Levels
GMWB (excluding life-contingent portions)
Fair Value
Equity Market Levels / Implied Volatility / Interest Rates
[1]
Each of these guarantees and the related U.S. GAAP accounting volatility will also be influenced by actual and estimated policyholder behavior.
Risk Hedging
Variable Annuity Hedging Program
The Company’s variable annuity hedging is primarily focused on reducing the economic exposure to market risks associated with guaranteed benefits that are embedded in our global variable annuity contracts, through the use of reinsurance and capital market derivative instruments. The variable annuity hedging also considers the potential impacts on Statutory accounting results.

97


Reinsurance
The Company uses reinsurance for a portion of contracts with GMWB riders issued prior to the third quarter of 2003 and GMWB risks associated with a block of business sold between the third quarter of 2003 and the second quarter of 2006. The Company also uses reinsurance for a majority of the GMDB issued.
Capital Market Derivatives
GMWB Hedge Program
The Company enters into derivative contracts to hedge market risk exposures associated with the GMWB liabilities that are not reinsured. These derivative contracts include customized swaps, interest rate swaps and futures, and equity swaps, options, and futures, on certain indices including the S&P 500 index, EAFE index, and NASDAQ index.
Additionally, the Company holds customized derivative contracts to provide protection from certain capital market risks for the remaining term of specified blocks of non-reinsured GMWB riders. These customized derivative contracts are based on policyholder behavior assumptions specified at the inception of the derivative contracts. The Company retains the risk for differences between assumed and actual policyholder behavior and between the performance of the actively managed funds underlying the separate accounts and their respective indices.
While the Company actively manages this dynamic hedging program, increased U.S. GAAP earnings volatility may result from factors including, but not limited to: policyholder behavior, capital markets, divergence between the performance of the underlying funds and the hedging indices, changes in hedging positions and the relative emphasis placed on various risk management objectives.
Macro Hedge Program
The Company’s macro hedging program uses derivative instruments, such as options and futures on equities and interest rates, to provide protection against the statutory tail scenario risk arising from GMWB and GMDB liabilities on the Company’s statutory surplus. These macro hedges cover some of the residual risks not otherwise covered by specific dynamic hedging program. Management assesses this residual risk under various scenarios in designing and executing the macro hedge program. The macro hedge program will result in additional U.S. GAAP earnings volatility as changes in the value of the macro hedge derivatives, which are designed to reduce statutory reserve and capital volatility, may not be closely aligned to changes in GAAP liabilities.
Variable Annuity Hedging Program Sensitivities
The underlying guaranteed living benefit liabilities and the related hedge assets within the GMWB (excluding life contingent GMWB contracts) and Macro hedge programs are carried at fair value, with the exception of liabilities within the Macro hedge program.
The following table presents our estimates of the potential instantaneous impacts from sudden market stresses related to equity market prices, interest rates, and implied market volatilities. The following sensitivities represent: (1) the net estimated difference between the change in the fair value of GMWB liabilities and the underlying hedge instruments and (2) the estimated change in fair value of the hedge instruments for the macro program, before the impacts of amortization of DAC, and taxes. As noted in the preceding discussion, certain hedge assets are used to hedge liabilities that are not carried at fair value and will not have a liability offset in the U.S. GAAP sensitivity analysis. All sensitivities are measured as of March 31, 2015 and are related to the fair value of liabilities and hedge instruments in place at that date for the Company’s variable annuity hedge programs. The impacts presented in the table that follows are estimated individually and measured without consideration of any correlation among market risk factors.
GAAP Sensitivity Analysis
As of March 31, 2015
(before tax and DAC) [1]
GMWB
Macro
Equity Market Return
-20
 %
-10
 %
10
 %
-20
 %
-10
 %
10
 %
Potential Net Fair Value Impact
$
(25
)
$
(10
)
$
6

$
163

$
65

$
(44
)
Interest Rates
-50 bps

-25 bps

25 bps

-50 bps

-25 bps

25 bps

Potential Net Fair Value Impact
$
(2
)
$
(1
)
$

$
14

$
7

$
(6
)
Implied Volatilities
10
 %
2
 %
-10
 %
10
 %
2
 %
-10
 %
Potential Net Fair Value Impact
$
(14
)
$
(2
)
$
7

$
110

$
22

$
(108
)
[1]
These sensitivities are based on the following key market levels as of March 31, 2015: 1) S&P of 2068; 2) 10yr US swap rate of 2.07%; and 3) S&P 10yr volatility of 27.59%.

98


The preceding sensitivity analysis is an estimate and should not be used to predict the future financial performance of the Company’s variable annuity hedge programs. The actual net changes in the fair value liability and the hedging assets illustrated in the preceding table may vary materially depending on a variety of factors which include but are not limited to:
The sensitivity analysis is only valid as of the measurement date and assumes instantaneous changes in the capital market factors and no ability to rebalance hedge positions prior to the market changes;
Changes to the underlying hedging program, policyholder behavior, and variation in underlying fund performance relative to the hedged index, which could materially impact the liability; and
The impact of elapsed time on liabilities or hedge assets, any non-parallel shifts in capital market factors, or correlated moves across the sensitivities.

99



Financial Risk on Statutory Capital
Statutory surplus amounts and risk-based capital (“RBC”) ratios may increase or decrease in any period depending upon a variety of factors and may be compounded in extreme scenarios or if multiple factors occur at the same time. At times the impact of changes in certain market factors or a combination of multiple factors on RBC ratios can be counterintuitive. Factors include:
In general, as equity market levels and interest rates decline, the amount and volatility of both our actual potential obligation, as well as the related statutory surplus and capital margin for death and living benefit guarantees associated with variable annuity contracts can be materially negatively affected, sometimes at a greater than linear rate. Other market factors that can impact statutory surplus, reserve levels and capital margin include differences in performance of variable subaccounts relative to indices and/or realized equity and interest rate volatilities. In addition, as equity market levels increase, generally surplus levels will increase. RBC ratios will also tend to increase when equity markets increase. However, as a result of a number of factors and market conditions, including the level of hedging costs and other risk transfer activities, reserve requirements for death and living benefit guarantees and RBC requirements could increase with rising equity markets, resulting in lower RBC ratios. Non-market factors, which can also impact the amount and volatility of both our actual potential obligation, as well as the related statutory surplus and capital margin, include actual and estimated policyholder behavior experience as it pertains to lapsation, partial withdrawals, and mortality.
As the value of certain fixed-income and equity securities in our investment portfolio decreases, due in part to credit spread widening, statutory surplus and RBC ratios may decrease.
As the value of certain derivative instruments that do not get hedge accounting decreases, statutory surplus and RBC ratios may decrease.
Our statutory surplus is also impacted by widening credit spreads as a result of the accounting for the assets and liabilities in our fixed market value adjusted (“MVA”) annuities. Statutory separate account assets supporting the fixed MVA annuities are recorded at fair value. In determining the statutory reserve for the fixed MVA annuities, we are required to use current crediting rates in the U.S. In many capital market scenarios, current crediting rates in the U.S. are highly correlated with market rates implicit in the fair value of statutory separate account assets. As a result, the change in statutory reserve from period to period will likely substantially offset the change in the fair value of the statutory separate account assets. However, in periods of volatile credit markets, such as we have experienced in 2008 and 2009, actual credit spreads on investment assets may increase sharply for certain sub-sectors of the overall credit market, resulting in statutory separate account asset market value losses. As actual credit spreads are not fully reflected in the current crediting rates in the U.S. the calculation of statutory reserves will not substantially offset the change in fair value of the statutory separate account assets resulting in reductions in statutory surplus. This has resulted and may continue to result in the need to devote significant additional capital to support the product.
With respect to our fixed annuity business, sustained low interest rates may result in a reduction in statutory surplus and an increase in NAIC required capital.
Most of these factors are outside of the Company’s control. The Company’s financial strength and credit ratings are significantly influenced by the statutory surplus amounts and RBC ratios of our insurance company subsidiaries. In addition, rating agencies may implement changes to their internal models that have the effect of increasing or decreasing the amount of statutory capital we must hold in order to maintain our current ratings.
The Company has reinsured approximately 28% of its risk associated with GMWB and 80% of its risk associated with the aggregate GMDB exposure. These reinsurance agreements serve to reduce the Company’s exposure to changes in the statutory reserves and the related capital and RBC ratios associated with changes in the capital markets. The Company also continues to explore other solutions for mitigating the capital market risk effect on surplus, such as internal and external reinsurance solutions, modifications to our hedging program, changes in product design and expense management.

100



Credit Risk
Credit risk is defined as the risk to earnings or capital due to uncertainty of an obligor’s or counterparty’s ability or willingness to meet its obligations in accordance with contractually agreed upon terms. The majority of the Company’s credit risk is concentrated in its investment holdings but is also present in reinsurance and insurance portfolios. Credit risk is comprised of three major factors: the risk of change in credit quality, or credit migration risk; the risk of default; and the risk of a change in value of a financial instrument due to changes in credit spread that are unrelated to changes in obligor credit quality. A decline in creditworthiness is typically associated with an increase in an investment’s credit spread, potentially resulting in an increase in other-than-temporary impairments and an increased probability of a realized loss upon sale.
The objective of the Company’s enterprise credit risk management strategy is to identify, quantify, and manage credit risk on an aggregate portfolio basis and to limit potential losses in accordance with an established credit risk management policy. The Company manages to its credit risk appetite by primarily holding a diversified mix of investment grade issuers and counterparties across its investment, reinsurance, and insurance portfolios. Potential losses are also limited within portfolios by diversifying across geographic regions, asset types, and sectors.
The Company manages credit risk exposure from its inception to its maturity or sale. Both the investment and reinsurance areas have formulated procedures for counterparty approvals and authorizations. Although approval processes may vary by area and type of credit risk, approval processes establish minimum levels of creditworthiness and financial stability. Credits considered for investment are subjected to prudent and conservative underwriting reviews. Within the investment portfolio, private securities, such as commercial mortgages, and private placements, must be presented to their respective review committees for approval.
Credit risks are managed on an on-going basis through the use of various processes and analyses. At the investment, reinsurance, and insurance product levels, fundamental credit analyses are performed at the issuer/counterparty level on a regular basis. To provide a holistic review within the investment portfolio, fundamental analyses are supported by credit ratings, assigned by nationally recognized rating agencies or internally assigned, and by quantitative credit analyses. The Company utilizes a credit value at risk ("VaR") to measure default and migration risk on a monthly basis. Issuer and security level risk measures are also utilized. In the event of deterioration in credit quality, the Company maintains watch lists of problem counterparties within the investment and reinsurance portfolios. The watch lists are updated based on regular credit examinations and management reviews. The Company also performs quarterly assessments of probable expected losses in the investment portfolio. The process is conducted on a sector basis and is intended to promptly assess and identify potential problems in the portfolio and to recognize necessary impairments.
Credit risk policies at the enterprise and operation level ensure comprehensive and consistent approaches to quantifying, evaluating, and managing credit risk under expected and stressed conditions. These policies define the scope of the risk, authorities, accountabilities, terms, and limits, and are regularly reviewed and approved by senior management and ERM. Aggregate counterparty credit quality and exposure is monitored on a daily basis utilizing an enterprise-wide credit exposure information system that contains data on issuers, ratings, exposures, and credit limits. Exposures are tracked on a current and potential basis. Credit exposures are reported regularly to the ERCC and to the Finance, Investment and Risk Management Committee. Exposures are aggregated by ultimate parent across investments, reinsurance receivables, insurance products with credit risk, and derivative counterparties. The credit database and reporting system are available to all key credit practitioners in the enterprise.
The Company exercises various and differing methods to mitigate its credit risk exposure within its investment and reinsurance portfolios. Some of the reasons for mitigating credit risk include financial instability or poor credit, avoidance of arbitration or litigation, future uncertainty, and exposure in excess of risk tolerances. Credit risk within the investment portfolio is most commonly mitigated through asset sales or the use of derivative instruments. Counterparty credit risk is mitigated through the practice of entering into contracts only with highly creditworthy institutions and through the practice of holding and posting of collateral. In addition, transactions cleared through a central clearing house reduce risk due to their ability to require daily variation margin, monitor the Company's ability to request additional collateral in the event of a counterparty downgrade, and be an independent valuation source. Systemic credit risk is mitigated through the construction of high-quality, diverse portfolios that are subject to regular underwriting of credit risks. For further discussion of the Company’s investment and derivative instruments, see the Portfolio Risks and Risk Management section and Note 5 - Investments and Derivative Instruments of Notes to Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements. For further discussion on managing and mitigating credit risk from the use of reinsurance via an enterprise security review process, see MD&A - Enterprise Risk Management, Insurance Risk Management, Reinsurance as a Risk Management Strategy.
As of March 31, 2015, the Company had no exposures to any credit concentration risk of a single issuer or counterparty greater than 10% of the Company’s stockholders’ equity, other than the U.S. government. For further discussion of concentration of credit risk, see the Concentration of Credit Risk section in Note 5 - Investments and Derivative Instruments of Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements in The Hartford’s 2014 Form 10-K Annual Report.

101



Derivative Instruments
The Company utilizes a variety of over-the-counter ("OTC"), OTC-cleared and exchange-traded derivative instruments as a part of its overall risk management strategy, as well as to enter into replication transactions. Derivative instruments are used to manage risk associated with interest rate, equity market, commodity market, credit spread, issuer default, price, and currency exchange rate risk or volatility. Replication transactions are used as an economical means to synthetically replicate the characteristics and performance of assets that are permissible investments under the Company’s investment policies. For further information on the Company’s use of derivatives, see Note 5 - Investments and Derivative Instruments of Notes to Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements.
Derivative activities are monitored and evaluated by the Company’s compliance and risk management teams and reviewed by senior management. In addition, the Company monitors counterparty credit exposure on a monthly basis to ensure compliance with Company policies and statutory limitations. The notional amounts of derivative contracts represent the basis upon which pay or receive amounts are calculated and are not reflective of credit risk. Downgrades to the credit ratings of The Hartford’s insurance operating companies may have adverse implications for its use of derivatives including those used to hedge benefit guarantees of variable annuities. In some cases, downgrades may give derivative counterparties for OTC derivatives and clearing brokers for OTC-cleared derivatives the right to cancel and settle outstanding derivative trades or require additional collateral to be posted. In addition, downgrades may result in counterparties and clearing brokers becoming unwilling to engage in or clear additional derivatives or may require collateralization before entering into any new trades. This will restrict the supply of derivative instruments commonly used to hedge variable annuity guarantees, particularly long-dated equity derivatives and interest rate swaps.
The Company uses various derivative counterparties in executing its derivative transactions. The use of counterparties creates credit risk that the counterparty may not perform in accordance with the terms of the derivative transaction. The Company has derivative counterparty exposure policies which limit the Company’s exposure to credit risk. The Company’s policies with respect to derivative counterparty exposure establishes market-based credit limits, favors long-term financial stability and creditworthiness of the counterparty and typically requires credit enhancement/credit risk reducing agreements. The Company minimizes the credit risk of derivative instruments by entering into transactions with high quality counterparties primarily rated A or better, which are monitored and evaluated by the Company’s risk management team and reviewed by senior management. The Company also generally requires that OTC derivative contracts be governed by an International Swaps and Derivatives Association ("ISDA") Master Agreement, which is structured by legal entity and by counterparty and permits right of offset.
The Company has developed credit exposure thresholds which are based upon counterparty ratings. Credit exposures are measured using the market value of the derivatives, resulting in amounts owed to the Company by its counterparties or potential payment obligations from the Company to its counterparties. The Company enters into credit support annexes in conjunction with the ISDA agreements, which require daily collateral settlement based upon agreed upon thresholds. For purposes of daily derivative collateral maintenance, credit exposures are generally quantified based on the prior business day’s market value and collateral is pledged to and held by, or on behalf of, the Company to the extent the current value of the derivatives exceed the contractual thresholds. In accordance with industry standard and the contractual agreements, collateral is typically settled on the next business day. The Company has exposure to credit risk for amounts below the exposure thresholds which are uncollateralized, as well as for market fluctuations that may occur between contractual settlement periods of collateral movements.
For the Company’s derivative programs, the maximum uncollateralized threshold for a derivative counterparty for a single legal entity is $10. The Company currently transacts OTC derivatives in five legal entities that have a threshold greater than zero; and therefore the maximum combined threshold for a single counterparty across all legal entities that use derivatives is $50. In addition, the Company may have exposure to multiple counterparties in a single corporate family due to a common credit support provider. As of March 31, 2015, the maximum combined threshold for all counterparties under a single credit support provider across all legal entities that use derivatives is $100. Based on the contractual terms of the collateral agreements, these thresholds may be immediately reduced due to a downgrade in either party’s credit rating. For further discussion, see the Derivative Commitments section of Note 8 - Commitments and Contingencies of the Notes to Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements.
For the three months ended March 31, 2015, the Company has incurred no losses on derivative instruments due to counterparty default.
In addition to counterparty credit risk, the Company may also introduce credit risk through the use of credit default swaps that are entered into to manage credit exposure. Credit default swaps involve a transfer of credit risk of one or many referenced entities from one party to another in exchange for periodic payments. The party that purchases credit protection will make periodic payments based on an agreed upon rate and notional amount, and for certain transactions there will also be an upfront premium payment. The second party, who assumes credit risk, will typically only make a payment if there is a credit event as defined in the contract and such payment will be typically equal to the notional value of the swap contract less the value of the referenced security issuer’s debt obligation. A credit event is generally defined as default on contractually obligated interest or principal payments or bankruptcy of the referenced entity.

102



The Company uses credit derivatives to purchase credit protection and to assume credit risk with respect to a single entity, referenced index, or asset pool. The Company purchases credit protection through credit default swaps to economically hedge and manage credit risk of certain fixed maturity investments across multiple sectors of the investment portfolio. The Company also enters into credit default swaps that assume credit risk as part of replication transactions. Replication transactions are used as an economical means to synthetically replicate the characteristics and performance of assets that are permissible investments under the Company’s investment policies. These swaps reference investment grade single corporate issuers and baskets, which include customized diversified portfolios of corporate issuers, which are established within sector concentration limits and may be divided into tranches which possess different credit ratings.
Investment Portfolio Risks and Risk Management
Investment Portfolio Composition
The following table presents the Company’s fixed maturities, AFS, by credit quality. The following average credit ratings referenced throughout this section are based on availability and are the midpoint of the applicable ratings among Moody’s, S&P, Fitch and Morningstar. If no rating is available from a rating agency, then an internally developed rating is used.
Fixed Maturities by Credit Quality
 
March 31, 2015
December 31, 2014
 
Amortized Cost
Fair Value
Percent of Total Fair Value
Amortized Cost
Fair Value
Percent of Total Fair Value
United States Government/Government agencies
$
7,682

$
8,214

13.6
%
$
7,135

$
7,596

12.8
%
AAA
7,776

8,100

13.4
%
6,963

7,251

12.2
%
AA
9,206

10,020

16.5
%
9,258

10,056

16.9
%
A
15,350

16,973

28.0
%
15,250

16,717

28.2
%
BBB
12,877

13,946

23.0
%
13,464

14,397

24.2
%
BB & below
3,213

3,302

5.5
%
3,292

3,367

5.7
%
Total fixed maturities, AFS
$
56,104

$
60,555

100
%
$
55,362

$
59,384

100
%
The value of securities in the AAA and A categories increased as compared to December 31, 2014, primarily due to purchases, as well as credit upgrades to certain collateralized loan obligations ("CLOs"), securities backed by states, municipalities and political subdivisions ("municipal bonds"), and investment grade corporate issuers. In addition, the value of securities in the BBB category has declined, primarily due to sales of securities in the energy and financial services sectors. Fixed maturities, FVO, are not included in the preceding table. For further discussion on FVO securities, see Note 4 - Fair Value Measurements of Notes to Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements.

103



The following table presents the Company’s AFS securities by type, as well as fixed maturities and equity, FVO.
Securities by Type
 
March 31, 2015
 
December 31, 2014
 
Cost or Amortized Cost
 
Gross Unrealized Gains
 
Gross Unrealized Losses
 
Fair Value
 
Percent of Total Fair Value
 
Cost or Amortized Cost
 
Gross Unrealized Gains
 
Gross Unrealized Losses
 
Fair Value
 
Percent of Total Fair Value
ABS
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Consumer loans
$
2,397

 
$
16

 
$
(27
)
 
$
2,386

 
3.9
%
 
$
2,052

 
$
14

 
$
(28
)
 
$
2,038

 
3.4
%
Small business
159

 
15

 
(7
)
 
167

 
0.3
%
 
166

 
14

 
(8
)
 
172

 
0.3
%
Other
441

 
10

 

 
451

 
0.7
%
 
252

 
11

 
(1
)
 
262

 
0.4
%
Collateralized debt obligations ("CDOs")
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 


 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
CLOs
2,404

 
7

 
(14
)
 
2,397

 
4.0
%
 
2,279

 
4

 
(17
)
 
2,266

 
3.8
%
Commercial real estate ("CREs")
104

 
82

 
(7
)
 
179

 
0.3
%
 
114

 
88

 
(9
)
 
193

 
0.3
%
Other [1]
383

 
26

 
(1
)
 
406

 
0.7
%
 
383

 
6

 
(10
)
 
382

 
0.6
%
Commercial mortgage-backed securities ("CMBS")
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Agency backed [2]
1,174

 
56

 

 
1,230

 
2.0
%
 
1,136

 
45

 
(1
)
 
1,180

 
2.0
%
Bonds
2,689

 
142

 
(3
)
 
2,828

 
4.7
%
 
2,594

 
126

 
(4
)
 
2,716

 
4.6
%
Interest only (“IOs”)
582

 
25

 
(13
)
 
594

 
1.0
%
 
505

 
25

 
(11
)
 
519

 
0.9
%
Corporate
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 


 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Basic industry
1,447

 
110

 
(9
)
 
1,548

 
2.6
%
 
1,673

 
105

 
(22
)
 
1,756

 
3.0
%
Capital goods
1,778

 
186

 
(4
)
 
1,960

 
3.2
%
 
1,880

 
192

 
(4
)
 
2,068

 
3.5
%
Consumer cyclical
1,731

 
149

 
(5
)
 
1,875

 
3.1
%
 
1,647

 
128

 
(8
)
 
1,767

 
3.0
%
Consumer non-cyclical
3,526

 
341

 
(3
)
 
3,864

 
6.4
%
 
3,473

 
335

 
(5
)
 
3,803

 
6.4
%
Energy
2,643

 
267

 
(31
)
 
2,879

 
4.8
%
 
3,092

 
252

 
(49
)
 
3,295

 
5.5
%
Financial services
5,297

 
427

 
(67
)
 
5,657

 
9.3
%
 
4,942

 
405

 
(94
)
 
5,253

 
8.8
%
Tech./comm.
3,207

 
416

 
(4
)
 
3,619

 
6.0
%
 
3,150

 
370

 
(12
)
 
3,508

 
5.9
%
Transportation
888

 
87

 
(2
)
 
973

 
1.6
%
 
891

 
82

 
(4
)
 
969

 
1.6
%
Utilities
4,045

 
556

 
(12
)
 
4,589

 
7.6
%
 
4,278

 
496

 
(13
)
 
4,761

 
8.0
%
Other
136

 
19

 

 
155

 
0.3
%
 
162

 
17

 

 
179

 
0.3
%
Foreign govt./govt. agencies
1,310

 
69

 
(14
)
 
1,365

 
2.3
%
 
1,592

 
73

 
(29
)
 
1,636

 
2.8
%
Municipal bonds
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Taxable
1,180

 
153

 
(1
)
 
1,332

 
2.2
%
 
1,135

 
135

 
(2
)
 
1,268

 
2.1
%
Tax-exempt
10,476

 
1,036

 
(2
)
 
11,510

 
19.0
%
 
10,600

 
1,006

 
(3
)
 
11,603

 
19.5
%
RMBS
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 


 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Agency
2,364

 
108

 
(1
)
 
2,471

 
4.1
%
 
2,448

 
98

 
(2
)
 
2,544

 
4.3
%
Non-agency
78

 
3

 

 
81

 
0.1
%
 
81

 
3

 

 
84

 
0.1
%
Alt-A
107

 
1

 

 
108

 
0.2
%
 
55

 
1

 

 
56

 
0.1
%
Sub-prime
1,414

 
20

 
(16
)
 
1,418

 
2.3
%
 
1,231

 
20

 
(17
)
 
1,234

 
2.1
%
U.S. Treasuries
4,144

 
371

 
(2
)
 
4,513

 
7.5
%
 
3,551

 
326

 
(5
)
 
3,872

 
6.5
%
Fixed maturities, AFS
56,104

 
4,698

 
(245
)
 
60,555

 
100
%
 
55,362

 
4,377

 
(358
)
 
59,384

 
100
%
Equity securities
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Financial services
129

 
13

 

 
142

 
19.0
%
 
149

 
13

 

 
162

 
23.2
%
Other
597

 
35

 
(28
)
 
604

 
81.0
%
 
527

 
37

 
(27
)
 
537

 
76.8
%
Equity securities, AFS
726

 
48

 
(28
)
 
746

 
100
%
 
676

 
50

 
(27
)
 
699

 
100
%
Total AFS securities
$
56,830

 
$
4,746

 
$
(273
)
 
$
61,301

 
 
 
$
56,038

 
$
4,427

 
$
(385
)
 
$
60,083

 
 
Fixed maturities, FVO
 
 
 
 
 
 
$
520

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
$
488

 
 
Equity, FVO [3]
 
 
 
 
 
 
$
402

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
$
348

 
 
[1]
Gross unrealized gains (losses) exclude the fair value of bifurcated embedded derivative features of certain securities. Changes in value are recorded in net realized capital gains (losses).
[2]
Includes securities with pools of loans issued by the Small Business Administration which are backed by the full faith and credit of the U.S. government.
[3]
Included in equity securities, AFS on the Condensed Consolidated Balance Sheets.

104



The increase in the fair value of AFS and FVO securities as compared to December 31, 2014 is primarily attributable to higher valuations as a result of a decrease in long term interest rates and the reinvestment of short-term assets into fixed maturities. The increase also reflects the purchase of U.S. Treasuries with the proceeds received from repurchase agreements; for further information on repurchase agreements refer to Note 5 - Investments and Derivative Instruments of Notes to Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements.
Energy Exposure
Market values of securities in the energy sector have continued to experience volatility in the first quarter of 2015. After experiencing a steep decline in prices in the second half of 2014, price continued their decline in 2015. West Texas Intermediate ("WTI") crude oil is the benchmark for oil prices in the United States. Prices for WTI futures contracts for one month forward delivery have declined 9%, from a price of $53 a barrel as of December 31, 2014, to $48 a barrel as of March 31, 2015, and have declined 56% from a June 2014 high of $108 a barrel. The drop in oil prices is primarily due to an a continued supply imbalance, lower than expected growth in global demand, and a stronger U.S. dollar. The speed and severity of the decline in oil prices has caused credit spreads to widen for corporate and sovereign issuers that generate a large portion of their revenues from oil. The impact was more pronounced on issuers with below investment grade credit. Ultimately, the impact on these issuers will be determined by the severity and duration of the decline in oil prices and the ability of the issuers to adjust their cost structure or find other sources of revenue.
The Company has limited direct exposure within its investment portfolio to the energy sector, totaling only 4% of total invested assets as of March 31, 2015, and is primarily comprised of corporate debt. As a result of the continued decline in prices, the Company reduced the amortized cost of its exposure to the energy sector in the first quarter by $588. The Company's energy sector investments as of March 31, 2015 are primarily comprised of investment grade securities and the exposure is diversified by issuer and in different sub-sectors of the energy market. The following table summarizes the Company's exposure to the energy sector by sector and credit quality.
 
March 31, 2015
 
Corporate & Equity Securities [1]
Foreign govt./govt. agencies [1][2]
Total
 
Amortized Cost
Fair Value
Amortized Cost
Fair Value
Amortized Cost
Fair Value
Investment grade
$
2,419

$
2,692

$
206

$
206

$
2,625

$
2,898

Below investment grade
287

262

19

18

306

280

Equity, AFS
19

18



19

18

Total energy exposure
$
2,725

$
2,972

$
225

$
224

$
2,950

$
3,196

 
December 31, 2014
 
Corporate & Equity Securities [1]
Foreign govt./govt. agencies [1][2]
Total
 
Amortized Cost
Fair Value
Amortized Cost
Fair Value
Amortized Cost
Fair Value
Investment grade
$
2,923

$
3,162

$
268

$
266

$
3,191

$
3,428

Below investment grade
288

266

36

32

324

298

Equity, AFS
23

21



23

21

Total energy exposure
$
3,234

$
3,449

$
304

$
298

$
3,538

$
3,747

[1]
Included in fixed maturities, AFS and FVO, equity, AFS and short-term investments on the Condensed Consolidated Balance Sheets. Excludes equity securities, FVO with cost and fair value of $45 and $45, respectively, as of December 31, 2014, that are hedged with total return swaps. The Company did not hold any equity securities, FVO as of March 31, 2015.
[2]
Includes sovereigns for which oil exports are greater than 4% of gross domestic product.
The Company manages the credit risk associated with the energy sector within the investment portfolio on an on-going basis using macroeconomic analysis and issuer credit analysis. The Company considers alternate scenarios including oil prices remaining at low levels for an extended period and/or declining significantly below current levels. For additional details regarding the Company’s management of credit risks, see the Credit Risk Section of this MD&A. The Company has evaluated all available-for-sale securities for potential OTTI as of March 31, 2015 and December 31, 2014 and concluded that for the securities in an unrealized loss position, it is more likely than not that we will recover our entire amortized cost basis in the securities. In addition, the Company does not currently have the intent-to-sell, nor will we be required to sell, the securities in an unrealized loss position. For additional details regarding the Company’s impairment process, see the Other-Than-Temporary Impairments Section of this MD&A.

105



Emerging Market Exposure
Emerging market securities have been negatively impacted by lower European interest rates, increased political tension in eastern Europe, softer-than-expected economic growth, as well as trade and budget deficits, raising the potential for destabilizing capital outflows and rapid currency depreciation, causing bondholders to demand a higher yield which caused the fair value of securities held to decline. As mentioned in the preceding discussion, the decline in oil prices that has continued into 2015 has put added strain on certain emerging markets that rely on revenues derived from the energy sector. As a result of these factors, credit spreads for certain emerging market securities have been volatile and we expect continued sensitivity to geopolitical events, the ongoing evolution of Fed policy and other economic factors, including contagion risk.
The Company has limited direct exposure within its investment portfolio to emerging market issuers, totaling only 2% of total invested assets as of March 31, 2015, and is primarily comprised of sovereign and corporate debt issued in U.S. dollars. The Company identifies exposures with the issuers’ ultimate parent country of domicile, which may not be the country of the security issuer. The following table presents the Company’s exposure to securities within certain emerging markets currently under the greatest stress, defined as countries that had a sovereign S&P credit rating of B- or below; or countries that have had a current account deficit and have an average inflation level greater than 5% for the past six months, as of either March 31, 2015 or December 31, 2014.
 
March 31, 2015
December 31, 2014
 
Amortized Cost
Fair Value
Amortized Cost
Fair Value
Argentina
$
2

$
2

$
2

$
2

Brazil
33

30

123

120

India
27

26

37

37

Indonesia
66

67

82

80

Kazakhstan
51

46

79

73

Lebanon
21

21

29

29

South Africa
53

53

54

53

Turkey
48

48

65

67

Ukraine
1

1

3

3

Uruguay
17

18

16

17

Venezuela
2

2

4

2

Other
80

81

97

96

Total [1]
$
401

$
395

$
591

$
579

[1]
Includes an amortized cost and fair value of $207 and $196, respectively, as of March 31, 2015 and an amortized cost and fair value of $137 and $131, respectively, as of December 31, 2014 included in the exposure to the preceding energy sector table.
The Company manages the credit risk associated with emerging market securities within the investment portfolio on an on-going basis using macroeconomic analysis and issuer credit analysis subject to diversification and individual credit risk management limits. For additional details regarding the Company’s management of credit risk, see the Credit Risk section of this MD&A.
Due to the continued decline in oil prices, the Company significantly reduced its exposure during the first quarter of 2015 to countries that rely on the energy sector as a main source of their GDP, such as Brazil. In addition, the Company has reduced its exposure to the Russian Federation due to the political tension in the country.
Financial Services
The Company’s exposure to the financial services sector is predominantly through investment grade banking and insurance institutions. The following table presents the Company’s fixed maturity, AFS and equity, AFS securities in the financial services sector that are included in the preceding Securities by Type table.

106



 
March 31, 2015
 
December 31, 2014
 
Amortized Cost
 
Fair Value
 
Net Unrealized Gain/(Loss)
 
Amortized Cost
 
Fair Value
 
Net Unrealized Gain/(Loss)
AAA
$
52

 
$
54

 
$
2

 
$
31

 
$
34

 
$
3

AA
494

 
528

 
34

 
401

 
436

 
35

A
3,019

 
3,234

 
215

 
2,610

 
2,804

 
194

BBB
1,550

 
1,641

 
91

 
1,681

 
1,734

 
53

BB & below
311

 
342

 
31

 
368

 
407

 
39

Total
$
5,426

 
$
5,799

 
$
373

 
$
5,091

 
$
5,415

 
$
324

The Company's exposure to the financial services sector increased as compared to December 31, 2014 due to purchases of investment grade corporate securities, as well as an increase in valuations as a result of lower interest rates.
Commercial Real Estate
Commercial real estate market fundamentals, including property prices, financial conditions, transaction volume, and delinquencies, continue to improve. In addition, the availability of credit has increased and there is now less concern about the ability of borrowers to refinance as loans come due. The following table presents the Company’s exposure to CMBS bonds by current credit quality and vintage year, included in the preceding Securities by Type table. Credit protection represents the current weighted average percentage of the outstanding capital structure subordinated to the Company’s investment holding that is available to absorb losses before the security incurs the first dollar loss of principal and excludes any equity interest or property value in excess of outstanding debt.
CMBS – Bonds [1]
March 31, 2015
 
AAA
 
AA
 
A
 
BBB
 
BB and Below
 
Total
 
Amortized Cost
 
Fair Value
 
Amortized Cost
 
Fair Value
 
Amortized Cost
 
Fair Value
 
Amortized Cost
 
Fair Value
 
Amortized Cost
 
Fair Value
 
Amortized Cost
 
Fair Value
2004 & Prior
$
14

 
$
15

 
$
53

 
$
61

 
$

 
$

 
$

 
$

 
$
15

 
$
19

 
$
82

 
$
95

2005
120

 
133

 
64

 
66

 
116

 
117

 
63

 
64

 
25

 
25

 
388

 
405

2006
285

 
295

 
108

 
114

 
120

 
126

 
63

 
65

 
22

 
23

 
598

 
623

2007
225

 
235

 
156

 
168

 
78

 
83

 
16

 
16

 
71

 
72

 
546

 
574

2008
40

 
43

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 
40

 
43

2009
11

 
11

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 
11

 
11

2010
18

 
20

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 
18

 
20

2011
56

 
62

 

 

 

 

 
6

 
6

 

 

 
62

 
68

2012
40

 
42

 

 

 
18

 
19

 
30

 
30

 

 

 
88

 
91

2013
16

 
17

 
95

 
102

 
74

 
81

 
10

 
11

 
1

 
1

 
196

 
212

2014
350

 
369

 
66

 
69

 
59

 
61

 
6

 
6

 
2

 
2

 
483

 
507

2015
87

 
88

 
58

 
58

 
32

 
33

 

 

 

 

 
177

 
179

Total
$
1,262

 
$
1,330

 
$
600

 
$
638

 
$
497

 
$
520

 
$
194

 
$
198

 
$
136

 
$
142

 
$
2,689

 
$
2,828

Credit  protection
32.5%
 
26.1%
 
22.5%
 
17.9%
 
23.0%
 
27.7%

107



December 31, 2014
 
AAA
 
AA
 
A
 
BBB
 
BB and Below
 
Total
 
Amortized Cost
 
Fair Value
 
Amortized Cost
 
Fair Value
 
Amortized Cost
 
Fair Value
 
Amortized Cost
 
Fair Value
 
Amortized Cost
 
Fair Value
 
Amortized Cost
 
Fair Value
2004 & Prior
$
13

 
$
13

 
$
58

 
$
64

 
$
7

 
$
7

 
$

 
$

 
$
15

 
$
20

 
$
93

 
$
104

2005
175

 
188

 
78

 
80

 
99

 
101

 
83

 
84

 
46

 
46

 
481

 
499

2006
287

 
300

 
108

 
115

 
121

 
127

 
63

 
66

 
22

 
23

 
601

 
631

2007
211

 
221

 
169

 
182

 
78

 
82

 
31

 
31

 
72

 
73

 
561

 
589

2008
40

 
43

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 
40

 
43

2009
11

 
11

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 
11

 
11

2010
18

 
20

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 
18

 
20

2011
56

 
62

 

 

 

 

 
6

 
6

 

 

 
62

 
68

2012
40

 
41

 

 

 
14

 
14

 
12

 
12

 

 

 
66

 
67

2013
16

 
16

 
95

 
99

 
71

 
76

 
12

 
13

 

 

 
194

 
204

2014
350

 
360

 
64

 
66

 
53

 
54

 

 

 

 

 
467

 
480

Total
$
1,217

 
$
1,275

 
$
572

 
$
606

 
$
443

 
$
461

 
$
207

 
$
212

 
$
155

 
$
162

 
$
2,594

 
$
2,716

Credit 
protection
33.0%
 
25.7%
 
20.2%
 
19.5%
 
18.0%
 
27.2%
[1]
The vintage year represents the year the pool of loans was originated.
The Company also has exposure to CRE CDOs with an amortized cost and fair value of $104 and $179, respectively, as of March 31, 2015, and $114 and $193 respectively, as of December 31, 2014. These securities are comprised of diversified pools of commercial mortgage loans or equity positions of other CMBS securitizations. We continue to monitor these investments as economic and market uncertainties regarding future performance impact market liquidity and security premiums.
In addition to CMBS bonds and CRE CDOs, the Company has exposure to commercial mortgage loans as presented in the following table. These loans are collateralized by a variety of commercial properties and are diversified both geographically throughout the United States and by property type. These loans are primarily in the form of whole loans, where the Company is the sole lender, or may include participations. Loan participations are loans where the Company has purchased or retained a portion of an outstanding loan or package of loans and participates on a pro-rata basis in collecting interest and principal pursuant to the terms of the participation agreement. In general, A-Note participations have senior payment priority, followed by B-Note participations and then mezzanine loan participations. As of March 31, 2015, loans within the Company’s mortgage loan portfolio that have had extensions or restructurings, other than what is allowable under the original terms of the contract, are immaterial.
Commercial Mortgage Loans
 
March 31, 2015
 
December 31, 2014
 
Amortized Cost [1]
 
Valuation Allowance
 
Carrying Value
 
Amortized Cost [1]
 
Valuation Allowance
 
Carrying Value
Agricultural
$
51

 
$
(5
)
 
$
46

 
$
51

 
$
(5
)
 
$
46

Whole loans
5,477

 
(16
)
 
5,461

 
5,333

 
(13
)
 
5,320

A-Note participations
154

 

 
154

 
154

 

 
154

B-Note participations
17

 

 
17

 
17

 

 
17

Mezzanine loans
19

 

 
19

 
19

 

 
19

Total
$
5,718

 
$
(21
)
 
$
5,697

 
$
5,574

 
$
(18
)
 
$
5,556

[1]
Amortized cost represents carrying value prior to valuation allowances, if any.
Since December 31, 2014, the Company funded $248 of commercial whole loans with a weighted average loan-to-value (“LTV”) ratio of 66% and a weighted average yield of 3.76%. The Company continues to originate commercial whole loans within primary markets, such as office, industrial and multi-family, focusing on loans with strong LTV ratios and high quality property collateral. There were no mortgage loans held for sale as of March 31, 2015 or December 31, 2014.

108



Municipal Bonds
The following table summarizes the amortized cost, fair value, and weighted average credit quality of the Company's available-for-sale investments in municipal bonds.
 
March 31, 2015
 
December 31, 2014
 
Amortized Cost
 
Fair Value
 
Weighted Average Credit Quality
 
Amortized Cost
 
Fair Value
 
Weighted Average Credit Quality
General Obligation
$
2,254

 
$
2,476

 
AA
 
$
2,259

 
$
2,480

 
AA
Pre-Refunded [1]
752

 
791

 
AAA
 
716

 
748

 
AAA
Revenue


 


 

 


 


 

Transportation
1,503

 
1,696

 
A+
 
1,599

 
1,781

 
A+
Health Care
1,475

 
1,628

 
AA-
 
1,412

 
1,560

 
AA-
Water & Sewer
1,200

 
1,309

 
AA
 
1,204

 
1,308

 
AA
Education
1,127

 
1,247

 
AA
 
1,115

 
1,232

 
AA
Sales Tax
867

 
977

 
AA-
 
916

 
1,020

 
AA-
Leasing [2]
778

 
867

 
A+
 
772

 
858

 
AA-
Power
745

 
822

 
A+
 
739

 
814

 
A+
Housing
125

 
130

 
AA
 
148

 
153

 
AA
Other
830

 
899

 
AA-
 
855

 
917

 
AA-
Total Revenue
8,650

 
9,575

 
AA-
 
8,760

 
9,643

 
AA-
Total Municipal
$
11,656

 
$
12,842

 
AA-
 
$
11,735

 
$
12,871

 
AA-
[1]
Pre-Refunded bonds are bonds for which an irrevocable trust containing sufficient U.S. treasury, agency, or other securities has been established to fund the remaining payments of principal and interest.
[2]
Leasing revenue bonds are generally the obligations of a financing authority established by the municipality that leases facilities back to a municipality. The notes are typically secured by lease payments made by the municipality that is leasing the facilities financed by the issue. Lease payments may be subject to annual appropriation by the municipality or the municipality may be obligated to appropriate general tax revenues to make lease payments.
As of March 31, 2015 and December 31, 2014, the largest issuer concentrations were the states of Illinois, California and Massachusetts, which each comprised less than 3% of the municipal bond portfolio and were primarily comprised of general obligation and taxable bonds.
Limited Partnerships and Other Alternative Investments
The following table presents the Company’s investments in limited partnerships and other alternative investments which include hedge funds, mortgage and real estate funds, mezzanine debt funds, and private equity and other funds. Hedge funds are comprised of approximately half credit and equity related funds and approximately half global macro related funds with a market neutral focus. Mortgage and real estate funds consist of investments in funds whose assets consist of mortgage loans, mortgage loan participations, mezzanine loans or other notes which may be below investment grade, as well as equity real estate and real estate joint ventures. Mezzanine debt funds include investments in funds whose assets consist of subordinated debt that often incorporates equity-based options such as warrants and a limited amount of direct equity investments. Private equity and other funds primarily consist of investments in funds whose assets typically consist of a diversified pool of investments in small to mid-sized non-public businesses with high growth potential.
 
March 31, 2015
 
December 31, 2014
 
Amount
 
Percent
 
Amount
 
Percent
Hedge funds
$
1,160

 
39.7
%
 
$
1,187

 
40.3
%
Mortgage and real estate funds
549

 
18.8
%
 
561

 
19.1
%
Mezzanine debt funds
58

 
2.0
%
 
61

 
2.1
%
Private equity and other funds
1,156

 
39.5
%
 
1,133

 
38.5
%
Total
$
2,923

 
100
%
 
$
2,942

 
100
%
Available-for-Sale Securities — Unrealized Loss Aging
The total gross unrealized losses were $273 as of March 31, 2015, and have decreased $112, or 29%, from December 31, 2014 due to decreases in interest rates. As of March 31, 2015, $218 of the gross unrealized losses were associated with securities depressed less than 20% of cost or amortized cost.

109



The remaining $55 of gross unrealized losses were associated with securities depressed greater than 20%. The securities depressed more than 20% are corporate securities within the energy sector, as well as securities with exposure to commercial real estate that have market spreads that continue to be wider than the spreads at the securities' respective purchase dates. Unrealized losses on corporate debt securities in the energy sector are primarily the result of the recent decline in oil prices previously discussed; see Exposure to the Energy Sector in the Investment Portfolio Risks and Risk Management section of this MD&A. Unrealized losses on securities with exposure to commercial real estate are largely due to the continued market and economic uncertainties surrounding the performance of certain structures or vintages. Based upon the Company’s cash flow modeling and current market and collateral performance assumptions, these securities with exposure to commercial real estate have sufficient credit protection levels to receive contractually obligated principal and interest payments.
As part of the Company’s ongoing security monitoring process, the Company has reviewed its AFS securities in an unrealized loss position and concluded that these securities are temporarily depressed and are expected to recover in value as the securities approach maturity or as market spreads tighten. For these securities in an unrealized loss position where a credit impairment has not been recorded, the Company’s best estimate of expected future cash flows are sufficient to recover the amortized cost basis of the security. Furthermore, the Company neither has an intention to sell nor does it expect to be required to sell these securities. For further information regarding the Company’s impairment analysis, see Other-Than-Temporary Impairments in the Investment Portfolio Risks and Risk Management section of this MD&A.
The following table presents the Company’s unrealized loss aging for AFS securities by length of time the security was in a continuous unrealized loss position:
 
March 31, 2015
 
December 31, 2014
Consecutive Months
Items
 
Cost or Amortized Cost
 
Fair Value
 
Unrealized Loss [1]
 
Items
 
Cost or Amortized Cost
 
Fair Value
 
Unrealized Loss [1]
Three months or less
1,103

 
$
3,177

 
$
3,138

 
$
(39
)
 
1,412

 
$
4,014

 
$
3,963

 
$
(51
)
Greater than three to six months
497

 
978

 
957

 
(21
)
 
643

 
1,739

 
1,665

 
(74
)
Greater than six to nine months
406

 
851

 
820

 
(31
)
 
220

 
417

 
404

 
(13
)
Greater than nine to eleven months
149

 
222

 
217

 
(5
)
 
102

 
148

 
142

 
(6
)
Twelve months or more
585

 
3,257

 
3,078

 
(177
)
 
688

 
4,667

 
4,429

 
(241
)
Total
2,740

 
$
8,485

 
$
8,210

 
$
(273
)
 
3,065

 
$
10,985

 
$
10,603

 
$
(385
)
[1]
Unrealized losses exclude the fair value of bifurcated embedded derivative features of certain securities as changes in value are recorded in net realized capital gains (losses).
The following tables present the Company’s unrealized loss aging for AFS securities continuously depressed over 20% by length of time (included in the preceding table):
 
March 31, 2015
 
December 31, 2014
Consecutive Months
Items
 
Cost or Amortized Cost
 
Fair Value
 
Unrealized Loss [1]
 
Items
 
Cost or Amortized Cost
 
Fair Value
 
Unrealized Loss [1]
Three months or less
103

 
$
122

 
$
93

 
$
(29
)
 
137

 
$
152

 
$
113

 
$
(39
)
Greater than three to six months
73

 
40

 
28

 
(12
)
 
39

 
17

 
11

 
(6
)
Greater than six to nine months
23

 
5

 
3

 
(2
)
 
11

 
4

 
1

 
(3
)
Greater than nine to eleven months
9

 
2

 
1

 
(1
)
 
9

 
1

 

 
(1
)
Twelve months or more
50

 
27

 
16

 
(11
)
 
49

 
31

 
19

 
(12
)
Total
258

 
$
196

 
$
141

 
$
(55
)
 
245

 
$
205

 
$
144

 
$
(61
)
[1]
Unrealized losses exclude the fair value of bifurcated embedded derivatives features of certain securities as changes in value are recorded in net realized capital gains (losses).
 

110



Other-Than-Temporary Impairments
The following table presents the Company’s impairments recognized in earnings by security type:
 
Three Months Ended March 31,
 
2015
2014
CRE CDOs
$
1

$

Corporate
5

18

Equity
1

2

RMBS
 
 
Agency

2

Sub-prime
1


Foreign government
4


Total
$
12

$
22

Three months ended March 31, 2015
For the three months ended March 31, 2015, impairments recognized in earnings were comprised of securities the Company intends to sell of $9 and credit impairments of $3.
Impairments for the the three months ended March 31, 2015 were primarily impairments on securities the Company has made the decision to sell. Credit impairments for the three months ended March 31, 2015 were primarily identified through security specific reviews and resulted from changes in the financial condition and near term prospects of certain issuers. The Company incorporates its best estimate of future performance using internal assumptions and judgments that are informed by economic and industry specific trends, as well as our expectations with respect to security specific developments.
There were no material non-credit impairments recognized in other comprehensive income for the three months ended March 31, 2015. These non-credit impairments represent the difference between fair value and the Company’s best estimate of expected future cash flows discounted at the security’s effective yield prior to impairment, rather than at current market implied credit spreads. These non-credit impairments primarily represent increases in market liquidity premiums and credit spread widening that occurred after the securities were purchased, as well as a discount for variable-rate coupons which are paying less than at purchase date. In general, larger liquidity premiums and wider credit spreads are the result of deterioration of the underlying collateral performance of the securities, as well as the risk premium required to reflect future uncertainty in the real estate market.
Future impairments may develop as the result of changes in intent to sell specific securities or if actual results underperform current modeling assumptions, which may be the result of, but are not limited to, macroeconomic factors and security-specific performance below current expectations. Ultimate loss formation will be a function of macroeconomic factors and idiosyncratic security-specific performance.
Three months ended March 31, 2014
For the three months ended March 31, 2014, impairments recognized in earnings were comprised of credit impairments of $18, securities that the Company intends to sell of $2 , impairments on equity securities of $2. Credit impairments for the three months ended March 31, 2014, were primarily concentrated in private placements and corporate securities.

111



CAPITAL RESOURCES AND LIQUIDITY
The following section discusses the overall financial strength of The Hartford and its insurance operations including their ability to generate cash flows from each of their business segments, borrow funds at competitive rates and raise new capital to meet operating and growth needs over the next twelve months.
Liquidity Requirements and Sources of Capital
The Hartford Financial Services Group, Inc. (Holding Company)
The liquidity requirements of the holding company of The Hartford Financial Services Group, Inc. (“HFSG Holding Company”) have been and will continue to be met by HFSG Holding Company’s fixed maturities, short-term investments and cash, dividends from its subsidiaries, principally its insurance operations, as well as the issuance of common stock, debt or other capital securities and borrowings from its credit facilities, as needed.
As of March 31, 2015, HFSG Holding Company held fixed maturities, short-term investments and cash of $2.0 billion. Expected liquidity requirements of the HFSG Holding Company for the next twelve months include payment of 7.3% senior notes of $167 at maturity, interest payments on debt of approximately $350 and common stockholder dividends, subject to the discretion of the Board of Directors, of approximately $300.
The Hartford has an intercompany liquidity agreement that allows for short-term advances of funds among the HFSG Holding Company and certain affiliates of up to $2.0 billion for liquidity and other general corporate purposes. The Connecticut Insurance Department ("CTDOI") granted approval for certain affiliated insurance companies that are parties to the agreement to treat receivables from a parent, including the HFSG Holding Company, as admitted assets for statutory accounting purposes. As of March 31, 2015, there were no amounts outstanding with the HFSG holding company.
Equity
The Company's total authorization for equity repurchases is $2.775 billion for the period January 1, 2014 through December 31, 2015, with $729 remaining as of March 31, 2015.
During the three months ended March 31, 2015, the Company repurchased 6.1 million common shares for $250. During the period April 1, 2015 to April 22, 2015, the Company repurchased 1.5 million common shares for $65.
Debt
On April 24, 2015 the Company announced that it will redeem for cash the entire $296 aggregate principal amount outstanding of 4.000% senior notes due October 15, 2017 (the "2017 Notes") on May 27, 2015. The 2017 Notes will be redeemed at an estimated redemption price of approximately $320 including a make-whole premium and any interest accrued and unpaid to the redemption date. The Company expects to use cash on hand to finance the redemption.
Under the debt capital management program, the Company expects to use the remaining authorization of approximately $180 for other debt repayment actions during 2015. Any repurchase of debt under the capital management program is dependent on market conditions.
Intercompany liquidity agreements
On January 29, 2015 Hartford Insurance Company of the Midwest, an indirect wholly-owned subsidiary of the Company, issued a Revolving Note (the "Note") in the principal amount of $58 to Hartford Fire Insurance Company, a subsidiary of the Company, under the intercompany liquidity agreement. The Note matured on March 31, 2015.
Dividends
On February 26, 2015, The Hartford’s Board of Directors declared a quarterly dividend of $0.18 per common share payable on April 1, 2015 to common shareholders of record as of March 9, 2015. There are no current restrictions on the HFSG Holding Company's ability to pay dividends to its shareholders. For a discussion of restrictions on dividends to the HFSG Holding Company from its insurance subsidiaries, see the following "Dividends from Insurance Subsidiaries" discussion. For a discussion of potential restrictions on the HFSG Holding Company's ability to pay dividends, see the risk factor "Our ability to declare and pay dividends is subject to limitations" in Item 1A of Part I of the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2014.

112



Pension Plans and Other Postretirement Benefits
While the Company has significant discretion in making voluntary contributions to the U. S. qualified defined benefit pension plan, the Employee Retirement Income Security Act of 1974, as amended by the Pension Protection Act of 2006, the Worker, Retiree, and Employer Recovery Act of 2008, the Preservation of Access to Care for Medicare Beneficiaries and Pension Relief Act of 2010, the Moving Ahead for Progress in the 21st Century Act of 2012 (MAP-21), and Internal Revenue Code regulations mandate minimum contributions in certain circumstances. The Company does not have a 2015 required minimum funding contribution for the U.S. qualified defined benefit pension plan and the funding requirements for all pension plans are expected to be immaterial. The Company has not determined whether, and to what extent, contributions may be made to the U.S. qualified defined benefit pension plan in 2015. The Company will monitor the funded status of the U.S. qualified defined benefit pension plan during 2015 to make this determination.
Dividends from Insurance Subsidiaries
Dividends to the HFSG Holding Company from its insurance subsidiaries are restricted by insurance regulation. The payment of dividends by Connecticut-domiciled insurers is limited under the insurance holding company laws of Connecticut. These laws require notice to and approval by the state insurance commissioner for the declaration or payment of any dividend, which, together with other dividends or distributions made within the preceding twelve months, exceeds the greater of (i) 10% of the insurer’s policyholder surplus as of December 31 of the preceding year or (ii) net income (or net gain from operations, if such company is a life insurance company) for the twelve-month period ending on the thirty-first day of December last preceding, in each case determined under statutory insurance accounting principles. In addition, if any dividend of a Connecticut-domiciled insurer exceeds the insurer’s earned surplus, it requires the prior approval of the Connecticut Insurance Commissioner. The insurance holding company laws of the other jurisdictions in which The Hartford’s insurance subsidiaries are incorporated (or deemed commercially domiciled) generally contain similar (although in certain instances somewhat more restrictive) limitations on the payment of dividends. Dividends paid to HFSG Holding Company by its life insurance subsidiaries are further dependent on cash requirements of HLI and other factors. In addition to statutory limitations on paying dividends, the Company also takes other items into consideration when determining dividends from subsidiaries. These considerations include, but are not limited to expected earnings and capitalization of the subsidiary, regulatory capital requirements and liquidity requirements of the individual operating company.
As a result of an extraordinary dividend received in July 2014, Hartford Fire has no remaining ordinary dividend capacity for the twelve months following. As such, the Company does not anticipate taking any dividends from Hartford Fire until the third quarter of 2015. At such time, the Company’s property-casualty insurance subsidiaries are permitted to pay up to a maximum of approximately $1.5 billion in dividends to HFSG Holding Company without prior approval from the applicable insurance commissioner. In 2015, HFSG Holding Company anticipates receiving approximately $600 in dividends from its property-casualty insurance subsidiaries, net of any dividends paid by its property-casualty subsidiaries to fund interest payments on an intercompany note between HHI and Hartford Fire Insurance Company.
On January 30, 2015 HLA paid an extraordinary dividend of $100 based on approval received from the CTDOI. On March 30, 2015, HLA paid an ordinary dividend of $25 leaving approximately $130 of ordinary dividend capacity available for the remainder of 2015. HFSG Holding Company anticipates receiving an additional $75 of dividends from HLA during 2015.
On January 30, 2015, HLIC paid an extraordinary dividend of $500, based on approval received from the CTDOI. As a result of this dividend, HLIC has no ordinary dividend capacity for the remainder of 2015. HFSG Holding Company anticipates receiving an additional $500 of extraordinary dividends from HLIC during 2015.
Other Sources of Capital for the HFSG Holding Company
The Hartford endeavors to maintain a capital structure that provides financial and operational flexibility to its insurance subsidiaries, ratings that support its competitive position in the financial services marketplace (for further detail see Ratings within the Capital Resources and Liquidity section of MD&A), and shareholder returns. As a result, the Company may from time to time raise capital from the issuance of equity, equity-related debt or other capital securities and is continuously evaluating strategic opportunities. The issuance of debt, common equity, equity-related debt or other capital securities could result in the dilution of shareholder interests or reduced net income due to additional interest expense.
Shelf Registrations
On August 9, 2013, The Hartford filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission (the “SEC”) an automatic shelf registration statement (Registration No. 333-190506) for the potential offering and sale of debt and equity securities. The registration statement allows for the following types of securities to be offered: debt securities, junior subordinated debt securities, preferred stock, common stock, depositary shares, warrants, stock purchase contracts, and stock purchase units. Because The Hartford is a well-known seasoned issuer, as defined in Rule 405 under the Securities Act of 1933, the registration statement went effective immediately upon filing and The Hartford may offer and sell an unlimited amount of securities under the registration statement during its three-year life.

113



Contingent Capital Facility
The Hartford is party to a put option agreement that provides The Hartford with the right to require the Glen Meadow ABC Trust, a Delaware statutory trust, at any time and from time to time, to purchase The Hartford’s junior subordinated notes in a maximum aggregate principal amount not to exceed $500. Under the Put Option Agreement, The Hartford will pay the Glen Meadow ABC Trust premiums on a periodic basis, calculated with respect to the aggregate principal amount of Notes that The Hartford had the right to put to the Glen Meadow ABC Trust for such period. The Hartford has agreed to reimburse the Glen Meadow ABC Trust for certain fees and ordinary expenses. The Company holds a variable interest in the Glen Meadow ABC Trust where the Company is not the primary beneficiary. As a result, the Company did not consolidate the Glen Meadow ABC Trust. As of March 31, 2015, The Hartford has not exercised its right to require Glen Meadow ABC Trust to purchase the Notes. As a result, the Notes remain a source of capital for the HFSG Holding Company.
Commercial Paper and Revolving Credit Facility
Commercial Paper
The Hartford has as agreement with a dealer under a commercial paper program. While The Hartford’s maximum borrowings available under its commercial paper program are $1.0 billion, the Company is dependent upon market conditions to access short-term financing through the issuance of commercial paper to investors. As of March 31, 2015 there is no commercial paper outstanding.
Revolving Credit Facilities
The Company has a senior unsecured five-year revolving credit facility (the “Credit Facility”) that provides for borrowing capacity up to $1.0 billion of unsecured credit through October 31, 2019 available in U.S. dollars, Euro, Sterling, Canadian dollars and Japanese Yen. As of March 31, 2015, there were no borrowings outstanding under the Credit Facility. As of March 31, 2015, the Company was in compliance with all financial covenants under the Credit Facility.
Derivative Commitments
Certain of the Company’s derivative agreements contain provisions that are tied to the financial strength ratings of the individual legal entity that entered into the derivative agreement as set by nationally recognized statistical rating agencies. If the legal entity’s financial strength were to fall below certain ratings, the counterparties to the derivative agreements could demand immediate and ongoing full collateralization and in certain instances demand immediate settlement of all outstanding derivative positions traded under each impacted bilateral agreement. The settlement amount is determined by netting the derivative positions transacted under each agreement. If the termination rights were to be exercised by the counterparties, it could impact the legal entity’s ability to conduct hedging activities by increasing the associated costs and decreasing the willingness of counterparties to transact with the legal entity. The aggregate fair value of all derivative instruments with credit-risk-related contingent features that are in a net liability position as of March 31, 2015 is $1.1 billion. Of this $1.1 billion the legal entities have posted collateral of $1.3 billion in the normal course of business. In addition, the Company has posted collateral of $39 associated with a customized GMWB derivative. Based on derivative market values as of March 31, 2015 a downgrade of one level below the current financial strength ratings by either Moody’s or S&P could require approximately an additional $1 to be posted as collateral. Based on derivative market values as of March 31, 2015 a downgrade by either Moody’s or S&P of two levels below the legal entities’ current financial strength ratings could require approximately an additional $8 of assets to be posted as collateral. These collateral amounts could change as derivative market values change, as a result of changes in our hedging activities or to the extent changes in contractual terms are negotiated. The nature of the collateral that we would post, if required, would be primarily in the form of U.S. Treasury bills, U.S. Treasury notes and government agency securities.
As of March 31, 2015, the aggregate notional amount and fair value of derivative relationships that could be subject to immediate termination in the event of rating agency downgrades to either BBB+ or Baa1 was $360 and $10, respectively.
Insurance Operations
Current and expected patterns of claim frequency and severity or surrenders may change from period to period but continue to be within historical norms and, therefore, the Company’s insurance operations’ current liquidity position is considered to be sufficient to meet anticipated demands over the next twelve months, including any obligations related to the Company’s restructuring activities. For a discussion and tabular presentation of the Company’s current contractual obligations by period, refer to Off-Balance Sheet Arrangements and Aggregate Contractual Obligations within the Capital Resources and Liquidity section of the MD&A included in The Hartford’s 2014 Form 10-K Annual Report.
The principal sources of operating funds are premiums, fees earned from assets under management and investment income, while investing cash flows originate from maturities and sales of invested assets. The primary uses of funds are to pay claims, claim adjustment expenses, commissions and other underwriting expenses, taxes to purchase new investments and to make dividend payments to the HFSG Holding Company.
The Company’s insurance operations consist of property and casualty insurance products (collectively referred to as “Property & Casualty Operations”) and life insurance and legacy annuity products (collectively referred to as “Life Operations”).

114



Property & Casualty Operations
Property & Casualty Operations holds fixed maturity securities including a significant short-term investment position (securities with maturities of one year or less at the time of purchase) to meet liquidity needs.
As of March 31, 2015 Property & Casualty Operations’ fixed maturities, short-term investments, and cash are summarized as follows: 
Fixed maturities
$
25,655

Short-term investments
871

Cash
184

Less: Derivative collateral
173

Total
$
26,537

Liquidity requirements that are unable to be funded by Property & Casualty Operation’s short-term investments would be satisfied with current operating funds, including premiums received or through the sale of invested assets. A sale of invested assets could result in significant realized losses.
Life Operations
Life Operations’ total general account contractholder obligations are supported by $44 billion of cash and total general account invested assets, which includes a significant short-term investment position to meet liquidity needs.
As of March 31, 2015 Life Operations’ fixed maturities, short-term investments, and cash are summarized as follows:
Fixed maturities
$
34,230

Short-term investments
1,925

Cash
315

Less: Derivative collateral
1,436

Total
$
35,034

Capital resources available to fund liquidity upon contractholder surrender are a function of the legal entity in which the liquidity requirement resides. Generally, obligations of Group Benefits will be funded by Hartford Life and Accident Insurance Company. Obligations of Talcott Resolution will generally be funded by Hartford Life Insurance Company and Hartford Life and Annuity Insurance Company.
HLIC, an indirect wholly-owned subsidiary, became a member of the Federal Home Loan Bank of Boston (“FHLBB”) in May 2011. Membership allows HLIC access to collateralized advances, which may be used to support various spread-based businesses and enhance liquidity management. The Connecticut Department of Insurance (“CTDOI”) will permit HLIC to pledge up to $1.39 billion in qualifying assets to secure FHLBB advances for 2015. The amount of advances that can be taken are dependent on the asset types pledged to secure the advances. The pledge limit is recalculated annually based on statutory admitted assets and capital and surplus. HLIC would need to seek the prior approval of the CTDOI if there were a desire to exceed these limits. As of March 31, 2015, HLIC had no advances outstanding under the FHLBB facility.
 
As of
Contractholder Obligations
March 31, 2015
Total Life contractholder obligations
$
187,747

Less: Separate account assets [1]
135,803

General account contractholder obligations
$
51,944

Composition of General Account Contractholder Obligations
 
Contracts without a surrender provision and/or fixed payout dates [2]
$
22,252

U.S. Fixed MVA annuities and Other [3]
8,666

Guaranteed investment contracts (“GIC”) [4]
26

Other [5]
21,000

General account contractholder obligations
$
51,944

[1]
In the event customers elect to surrender separate account assets or international statutory separate accounts, Life Operations will use the proceeds from the sale of the assets to fund the surrender, and Life Operations’ liquidity position will not be impacted. In many instances Life Operations will receive a percentage of the surrender amount as compensation for early surrender (surrender charge), increasing Life Operations’ liquidity position. In addition, a surrender of variable annuity separate account or general account assets (see the following) will decrease Life Operations’ obligation for payments on guaranteed living and death benefits.

115



[2]
Relates to contracts such as payout annuities or institutional notes, other than guaranteed investment products with an MVA feature (discussed below) or surrenders of term life, group benefit contracts or death and living benefit reserves for which surrenders will have no current effect on Life Operations’ liquidity requirements.
[3]
Relates to annuities that are recorded in the general account (under U.S. GAAP as the contractholders are subject to the Company's credit risk, although these annuities are held in a statutory separate account. In the statutory separate account, Life Operations is required to maintain invested assets with a fair value greater than or equal to the MVA surrender value of the Fixed MVA contract. In the event assets decline in value at a greater rate than the MVA surrender value of the Fixed MVA contract, Life Operations is required to contribute additional capital to the statutory separate account. Life Operations will fund these required contributions with operating cash flows or short-term investments. In the event that operating cash flows or short-term investments are not sufficient to fund required contributions, the Company may have to sell other invested assets at a loss, potentially resulting in a decrease in statutory surplus. As the fair value of invested assets in the statutory separate account are generally equal to the MVA surrender value of the Fixed MVA contract, surrender of Fixed MVA annuities will have an insignificant impact on the liquidity requirements of Life Operations.
[4]
GICs are subject to discontinuance provisions which allow the policyholders to terminate their contracts prior to scheduled maturity at the lesser of the book value or market value. Generally, the market value adjustment reflects changes in interest rates and credit spreads. As a result, the market value adjustment feature in the GIC serves to protect the Company from interest rate risks and limit Life Operations’ liquidity requirements in the event of a surrender.
[5]
Surrenders of, or policy loans taken from, as applicable, these general account liabilities, which include the general account option for Life Operations' individual variable annuities and the variable life contracts of the former Individual Life business, the general account option for annuities of the former Retirement Plans business and universal life contracts sold by the former Individual Life business, may be funded through operating cash flows of Life Operations, available short-term investments, or Life Operations may be required to sell fixed maturity investments to fund the surrender payment. Sales of fixed maturity investments could result in the recognition of realized losses and insufficient proceeds to fully fund the surrender amount. In this circumstance, Life Operations may need to take other actions, including enforcing certain contract provisions which could restrict surrenders and/or slow or defer payouts. The Company has ceded reinsurance in connection with the sales of its Retirement Plans and Individual Life businesses in 2013 to MassMutual and Prudential, respectively. These reinsurance transactions do not extinguish the Company's primary liability on the insurance policies issued under these businesses.
Off-Balance Sheet Arrangements and Aggregate Contractual Obligations
There have been no material changes to the Company’s aggregate contractual obligations since the filing of the Company’s 2014 Form 10-K Annual Report. There have been no material changes to the Company's off-balance sheet arrangements since the filing of the Company’s 2014 Form 10-K Annual Report.
Capitalization
The capital structure of The Hartford as of March 31, 2015 and December 31, 2014 consisted of debt and stockholders’ equity, summarized as follows:
 
March 31, 2015
December 31, 2014
Change
Short-term debt (includes current maturities of long-term debt)
$
167

$
456

(63
)%
Long-term debt
5,653

5,653

 %
Total debt [1]
5,820

6,109

(5
)%
Stockholders’ equity excluding accumulated other comprehensive income (loss), net of tax (“AOCI”)
17,927

17,792

1
 %
AOCI, net of tax
1,150

928

24
 %
Total stockholders’ equity
$
19,077

$
18,720

2
 %
Total capitalization including AOCI
$
24,897

$
24,829

 %
Debt to stockholders’ equity
31
%
33
%
 
Debt to capitalization
23
%
25
%
 
[1]
Total debt of the Company excludes $69 and $71 of consumer notes as of March 31, 2015 and December 31, 2014, respectively.
The Hartford’s total capitalization increased $68, or 0.3%, from December 31, 2014 to March 31, 2015 primarily due to an increase in AOCI, net of tax. AOCI, net of tax, increased from December 31, 2014 to March 31, 2015 primarily due to net unrealized capital gains from securities.
For additional information on AOCI, net of tax, and unrealized capital gains from securities, see Note 10 - Changes in and Reclassifications From Accumulated Other Comprehensive Income, and Note 5 - Investments and Derivative Instruments of Notes to Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements.

116



Cash Flows
 
Three Months Ended March 31,
 
2015
2014
Net cash provided by operating activities
$
447

$
349

Net cash provided by investing activities
$
295

$
196

Net cash used for financing activities
$
(619
)
$
(685
)
Cash – end of period
$
500

$
1,285

Cash provided by operating activities increased in 2015 as compared to the prior year period primarily a result of a decrease in claims paid, partially offset by a decrease in cash received for other fees and considerations.
Cash provided by investing activities in 2015 primarily relates to net proceeds from short-term investments of $642, excluding proceeds reinvested in fixed maturities available-for-sale, partially offset by net payments for equity securities available-for-sale of $203. Cash provided by investing activities in 2014 primarily relates to net proceeds from available for sale securities of $451, partially offset by a decrease in the change in mortgage loans of $108.
Cash used for financing activities in 2015 consists primarily of $298 related to net withdrawals for investments and universal life products, repayment of debt of $289, and acquisition of treasury stock of $250, partially offset by $323 in proceeds from securities sold under repurchase agreements. Cash used for financing activities in 2014 consists primarily of $289 related to net activity for investments and universal life products, repayment of debt of $200, and acquisition of treasury stock of $300.
Operating cash flows for the three months ended March 31, 2015 and 2014 have been adequate to meet liquidity requirements.
Equity Markets
For a discussion of the potential impact of the equity markets on capital and liquidity, see the Enterprise Risk Management section of the MD&A.
Ratings
Ratings are an important factor in establishing competitive position in the insurance marketplace and impact the Company’s ability to access financing and its cost of borrowing. There can be no assurance that the Company’s ratings will continue for any given period of time, or that they will not be changed. In the event the Company’s ratings are downgraded, the Company’s competitive position, ability to access financing, and its cost of borrowing, may be adversely impacted.
On April 17, 2014 Standard & Poor's ("S&P") raised its financial strength and counterparty credit rating on Hartford Fire Insurance Company to A+ from A.  At the same time, S&P upgraded the senior unsecured debt rating of HFSG Holding Company to BBB+ from BBB. S&P's outlook for all companies listed in this ratings action is stable.
On April 23, 2015 Moody's Investor Service (Moody's) raised its financial strength ratings of Hartford Fire Insurance Company from A2 to A1, and Hartford Life and Accident Insurance Company from A3 to A2. Moody's also raised the debt ratings of HFSG Holding Company senior debt from Baa3 to Baa2 and commercial paper from P-3 to P-2, and affirmed the financial strength ratings of Hartford Life Insurance Company and Hartford Life and Annuity Insurance Company at Baa2. Moody's outlook for all companies listed in this ratings action is stable.
The following table summarizes The Hartford’s significant member companies’ financial strength ratings from the major independent rating organizations as of April 23, 2015.
Insurance Financial Strength Ratings:
A.M. Best
Standard & Poor’s
Moody’s
Hartford Fire Insurance Company
A
A+
A1
Hartford Life and Accident Insurance Company
A
A
A2
Hartford Life Insurance Company
A-
BBB+
Baa2
Hartford Life and Annuity Insurance Company
A-
BBB+
Baa2
Other Ratings:
 
 
 
The Hartford Financial Services Group, Inc.:
 
 
 
Senior debt
bbb+
BBB+
Baa2
Commercial paper
AMB-2
A-2
P-2

117



These ratings are not a recommendation to buy or hold any of The Hartford’s securities and they may be revised or revoked at any time at the sole discretion of the rating organization.
The agencies consider many factors in determining the final rating of an insurance company. One consideration is the relative level of statutory surplus necessary to support the business written. Statutory surplus represents the capital of the insurance company reported in accordance with accounting practices prescribed by the applicable state insurance department.
Statutory Surplus
The following table sets forth statutory surplus for the Company’s insurance companies as of March 31, 2015 and December 31, 2014:
 
March 31, 2015
December 31, 2014
U.S. life insurance subsidiaries
$
6,602

$
7,157

Property & Casualty insurance subsidiaries
8,447

8,069

Total
$
15,049

$
15,226

Statutory capital and surplus for the U.S. life insurance subsidiaries decreased by $555, primarily due to dividends and returns of capital of $625 and decreases in admitted deferred income tax of $178, partially offset by variable annuity surplus impacts of $143.
Statutory capital and surplus for property and casualty increased by $378, primarily due to statutory net income of $388.
Contingencies
Legal Proceedings – For a discussion regarding contingencies related to The Hartford’s legal proceedings, please see the information contained under “Litigation” in Note 8 - Commitments and Contingencies of the Notes to Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements and Part II, Item 1 Legal Proceedings, which are incorporated herein by reference.
Legislative Developments
Dodd-Frank Wall Street Reform and Consumer Protection Act of 2010 (the “Dodd-Frank Act”)
Since it was enacted in 2010, the Dodd-Frank act has resulted in significant changes to the regulation of the financial services industry, including changes to the rules governing derivatives, restrictions on proprietary trading by certain entities, the creation of a Federal Insurance Office within the U.S. Treasury, and enhancements to corporate governance rules, among other things. The Dodd-Frank Act requires significant rulemaking across numerous agencies within the federal government. Rulemaking, and implementation of newly-adopted rules, is ongoing and may affect our operations and governance in ways that could adversely affect our financial condition and results of operations.
Patient Protection and Affordable Care Act of 2010 (the "Affordable Care Act")
On March 23, 2010, the President signed the Affordable Care Act. The impact to The Hartford as an employer is consistent with other large employers. It is too early to tell how the Affordable Care Act will impact The Hartford's businesses. The Hartford’s core business does not involve the issuance of health insurance and we do not issue any products that insure customers under the Affordable Care Act’s individual mandate. There may be, nevertheless, impacts to The Hartford's businesses that are too early to identify as key aspects of the law are still not fully implemented. For example, private exchanges may provide The Hartford additional opportunities to market our group benefit products and services. Conversely, access to medical care and medical costs are a substantial component of both disability and workers compensation products offered by The Hartford. We are monitoring the impact of the Affordable Care Act on consumer, broker and medical provider behavior for leading indicators of changes in medical costs or loss payments primarily on the Company's workers' compensation and disability liabilities.
Social Security Disability Disability Insurance ("SSDI")

Uncertainty around the future of the SSDI program could impact the group disability market. Without changes to the federal funding of the SSDI program, the program is projected by its board to become insolvent in 2016. Since SSDI benefits are an offset to the benefits payable under group disability policies and workers compensation in certain states, any decrease in SSDI benefits, or changes in eligibility, could have an impact on the group disability and workers’ compensation markets, including reserve impacts and increases in the cost of benefits.


118



Budget of the United States Government
On February 2, 2015, the Obama Administration released its “Fiscal Year 2016, Budget of the U.S. Government” (the “Budget”). Although the Administration has not released proposed statutory language, the Budget includes proposals that if enacted, would affect the taxation of life insurance companies and certain life insurance products. In particular, the proposals would change the method used to determine the amount of dividend income received by a life insurance company on assets held in separate accounts used to support products, including variable life insurance and variable annuity contracts, which are eligible for the dividends received deduction (“DRD”). The DRD reduces the amount of dividend income subject to tax and is a significant component of the difference between the Company's actual tax expense and expected amount determined using the federal statutory tax rate of 35%. If this proposal were enacted, the Company's actual tax expense could increase, reducing earnings.
IMPACT OF NEW ACCOUNTING STANDARDS
For a discussion of accounting standards, see Note 1 - Basis of Presentation and Significant Accounting Policies of Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements included in The Hartford’s 2014 Form 10-K Annual Report and Note 1 - Basis of Presentation and Significant Accounting Policies of Notes to Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements in this Form 10-Q.
Item 3.
QUANTITATIVE AND QUALITATIVE DISCLOSURES ABOUT MARKET RISK
The information contained in the Financial Risk Management section of Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations is incorporated herein by reference.
Item 4.
CONTROLS AND PROCEDURES
Evaluation of disclosure controls and procedures
The Company’s principal executive officer and its principal financial officer, based on their evaluation of the Company’s disclosure controls and procedures (as defined in Exchange Act Rule 13a-15(e)) have concluded that the Company’s disclosure controls and procedures are effective for the purposes set forth in the definition thereof in Exchange Act Rule 13a-15(e) as of March 31, 2015.
Changes in internal control over financial reporting
There was no change in the Company's internal control over financial reporting that occurred during the Company's current fiscal quarter that has materially affected, or is reasonably likely to materially affect, the Company's internal control over financial reporting.

119



Part II. OTHER INFORMATION
Item 1.
LEGAL PROCEEDINGS
Litigation
The Hartford is involved in claims litigation arising in the ordinary course of business, both as a liability insurer defending or providing indemnity for third-party claims brought against insureds and as an insurer defending coverage claims brought against it. The Hartford accounts for such activity through the establishment of unpaid loss and loss adjustment expense reserves. Subject to the uncertainties in the following discussion under the caption “Asbestos and Environmental Claims,” management expects that the ultimate liability, if any, with respect to such ordinary-course claims litigation, after consideration of provisions made for potential losses and costs of defense, will not be material to the consolidated financial condition, results of operations or cash flows of The Hartford.
The Hartford is also involved in other kinds of legal actions, some of which assert claims for substantial amounts. These actions include, among others, and in addition to the matters in the following description, putative state and federal class actions seeking certification of a state or national class. Such putative class actions have alleged, for example, underpayment of claims or improper underwriting practices in connection with various kinds of insurance policies, such as personal and commercial automobile, property, disability, life and inland marine. The Hartford also is involved in individual actions in which punitive damages are sought, such as claims alleging bad faith in the handling of insurance claims or other allegedly unfair or improper business practices. Like many other insurers, The Hartford also has been joined in actions by asbestos plaintiffs asserting, among other things, that insurers had a duty to protect the public from the dangers of asbestos and that insurers committed unfair trade practices by asserting defenses on behalf of their policyholders in the underlying asbestos cases. Management expects that the ultimate liability, if any, with respect to such lawsuits, after consideration of provisions made for estimated losses, will not be material to the consolidated financial condition of The Hartford. Nonetheless, given the large or indeterminate amounts sought in certain of these actions, and the inherent unpredictability of litigation, the outcome in certain matters could, from time to time, have a material adverse effect on the Company’s results of operations or cash flows in particular quarterly or annual periods.
Apart from the inherent difficulty of predicting litigation outcomes, the following Mutual Funds Litigation discussion purports to seek substantial damages for unsubstantiated conduct spanning a multi-year period based on novel applications of complex legal theories. The alleged damages are not quantified or factually supported in the complaint, and, in any event, the Company’s experience shows that demands for damages often bear little relation to a reasonable estimate of potential loss. The matter is still in the early stages of litigation, with no substantive legal decisions by the court defining the scope of the claims or the potentially available damages; fact discovery is ongoing and expert discovery has not commenced. Accordingly, management cannot reasonably estimate the possible loss or range of loss, if any, or predict the timing of the eventual resolution of this matter.
Mutual Funds Litigation — In February 2011, a derivative action was brought on behalf of six Hartford retail mutual funds in the United States District Court for the District of New Jersey, alleging that Hartford Investment Financial Services, LLC (“HIFSCO”), an indirect subsidiary of the Company, received excessive advisory and distribution fees in violation of its statutory fiduciary duty under Section 36(b) of the Investment Company Act of 1940. HIFSCO moved to dismiss and, in September 2011, the motion was granted in part and denied in part, with leave to amend the complaint. In November 2011, plaintiffs filed an amended complaint on behalf of The Hartford Global Health Fund, The Hartford Conservative Allocation Fund, The Hartford Growth Opportunities Fund, The Hartford Inflation Plus Fund, The Hartford Advisors Fund, and The Hartford Capital Appreciation Fund. Plaintiffs seek to rescind the investment management agreements and distribution plans between HIFSCO and these funds and to recover the total fees charged thereunder or, in the alternative, to recover any improper compensation HIFSCO received, in addition to lost earnings. HIFSCO filed a partial motion to dismiss the amended complaint and, in December 2012, the court dismissed without prejudice the claims regarding distribution fees and denied the motion with respect to the advisory fees claims. In March 2014, the plaintiffs filed a new complaint that, among other things, added as new plaintiffs The Hartford Floating Rate Fund and The Hartford Small Company Fund and named as a defendant Hartford Funds Management Company, LLC (“HFMC”), an indirect subsidiary of the Company which assumed the role as advisor to the funds as of January 2013. In March 2015, the plaintiffs filed a new complaint that, among other things, removed The Hartford Small Company Fund as a plaintiff. Discovery is ongoing. HFMC and HIFSCO dispute the allegations and expect to file a motion for summary judgment in the second quarter of 2015.
Asbestos and Environmental Claims – As discussed in Item 2, Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations - Critical Accounting Estimates - Property and Casualty Insurance Product Reserves, Net of Reinsurance - Property & Casualty Other Operations Claims, The Hartford continues to receive asbestos and environmental claims that involve significant uncertainty regarding policy coverage issues. Regarding these claims, The Hartford continually reviews its overall reserve levels and reinsurance coverages, as well as the methodologies it uses to estimate its exposures. Because of the significant uncertainties that limit the ability of insurers and reinsurers to estimate the ultimate reserves necessary for unpaid losses and related expenses, particularly those related to asbestos, the ultimate liabilities may exceed the currently recorded reserves. Any such additional liability cannot be reasonably estimated now but could be material to The Hartford’s consolidated operating results and liquidity.

120



Item 1A.
RISK FACTORS
Investing in The Hartford involves risk. In deciding whether to invest in The Hartford, you should carefully consider the risk factors disclosed in Item 1A of Part I of the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2014, any of which could have a significant or material adverse effect on the business, financial condition, operating results or liquidity of The Hartford. This information should be considered carefully together with the other information contained in this report and the other reports and materials filed by The Hartford with the SEC.
Item 2.
UNREGISTERED SALES OF EQUITY SECURITIES AND USE OF PROCEEDS
Purchases of Equity Securities by the Issuer
The Company’s repurchase authorization, which expires on December 31, 2015, permits purchases of common stock, as well as warrants or other derivative securities. Repurchases may be made in the open market, through derivative, accelerated share repurchase and other privately negotiated transactions, and through plans designed to comply with Rule 10b5-1(c) under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended. The timing of any future repurchases will be dependent upon several factors, including the market price of the Company’s securities, the Company’s capital position, consideration of the effect of any repurchases on the Company’s financial strength or credit ratings, and other corporate considerations. The repurchase program may be modified, extended or terminated by the Board of Directors at any time.
The following table summarizes the Company’s repurchases of its common stock during the three months ended March 31, 2015:
Period
Total Number
of Shares
Purchased [1]
 
Average Price
Paid Per
Share
Total Number of Shares Purchased as Part of Publicly Announced Plans or Programs
Approximate Dollar Value
of Shares that May Yet Be
Purchased Under
the Plans or Programs
 
 
 
 
 
(in millions)
January 1, 2015 - January 31, 2015
2,510,700

 
$
40.17

2,510,700

$
878

February 1, 2015 - February 28, 2015
1,863,820

 
$
40.66

1,863,820

$
802

March 1, 2015 - March 31, 2015
1,753,634

 
$
41.91

1,753,634

$
729

Total
6,128,154

  
$
40.82

6,128,154

 
[1]
Excludes 1,298,123 shares in net settlement of employee tax withholding obligations related to equity awards under the Company's Incentive Stock Plan. These net share settlements had the effect of share repurchases by the Company as they reduced the number of shares that otherwise would have been issued as a result of the vesting of equity awards. The Company paid approximately $53 million in employee tax withholding obligations related to net share settlements in the three months ended March 31, 2015.
Item 6.
EXHIBITS
See Exhibits Index on page

121



SIGNATURE
Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, the registrant has duly caused this report to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned hereunto duly authorized.
 
 
The Hartford Financial Services Group, Inc.
 
 
(Registrant)
 
 
Date:
April 27, 2015
/s/ Scott R. Lewis
 
 
Scott R. Lewis
 
 
Senior Vice President and Controller
 
 
(Chief accounting officer and duly
authorized signatory)

122



THE HARTFORD FINANCIAL SERVICES GROUP, INC.
FOR THE QUARTER ENDED MARCH 31, 2015
FORM 10-Q
EXHIBITS INDEX
Exhibit No.
 
Description
 
 
 
15.01
 
Deloitte & Touche LLP Letter of Awareness.**
 
 
31.01
 
Certification of Christopher J. Swift pursuant to Section 302 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002.**
 
 
31.02
 
Certification of Beth A. Bombara pursuant to Section 302 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002.**
 
 
32.01
 
Certification of Christopher J. Swift pursuant to Section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002.**
 
 
32.02
 
Certification of Beth A. Bombara pursuant to Section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002.**
 
 
101.INS
 
XBRL Instance Document.**
 
 
101.SCH
 
XBRL Taxonomy Extension Schema.**
 
 
101.CAL
 
XBRL Taxonomy Extension Calculation Linkbase.**
 
 
101.DEF
 
XBRL Taxonomy Extension Definition Linkbase.**
 
 
101.LAB
 
XBRL Taxonomy Extension Label Linkbase.**
 
 
101.PRE
 
XBRL Taxonomy Extension Presentation Linkbase.**
 
 
**
 
Filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission as an exhibit to this report.

123